ETC 3803/3804

3803/3804 Group
SINGLE-CHIP 8-BIT CMOS MICROCOMPUTER
DESCRIPTION
The 3803/3804 group is the 8-bit microcomputer based on the 740
family core technology.
The 3803/3804 group is designed for household products, office
automation equipment, and controlling systems that require analog signal processing, including the A-D converter and D-A
converters.
The 3804 group is the version of the 3803 group to which an I2CBUS control function has been added.
FEATURES
●Basic machine-language instructions ...................................... 71
●Minimum instruction execution time ................................ 0.24 µs
(at 16.8 MHz oscillation frequency)
●Memory size
ROM ............................................................... 16 K to 60 K bytes
RAM ................................................................. 640 to 2048 bytes
●Programmable input/output ports ............................................ 56
●Software pull-up resistors ................................................. Built-in
●Interrupts
21 sources, 16 vectors ............................................... 3803 group
(external 8, internal 12, software 1)
23 sources, 16 vectors ............................................... 3804 group
(external 9, internal 13, software 1)
●Timers ........................................................................... 16-bit ✕ 1
8-bit ✕ 4
(with 8-bit prescaler)
●Watchdog timer ............................................................ 16-bit ✕ 1
●Serial I/O ...................... 8-bit ✕ 2 (UART or Clock-synchronized)
8-bit ✕ 1 (Clock-synchronized)
●PWM ............................................ 8-bit ✕ 1 (with 8-bit prescaler)
●I2C-BUS interface (3804 group only) ........................... 1 channel
●A-D converter ............................................. 10-bit ✕ 16 channels
(8-bit reading enabled)
●D-A converter ................................................. 8-bit ✕ 2 channels
●LED direct drive port .................................................................. 8
●Clock generating circuit ..................................... Built-in 2 circuits
(connect to external ceramic resonator or quartz-crystal oscillator)
●Power source voltage
In high-, middle-speed mode
At 16.8 MHz oscillation frequency ............................ 4.5 to 5.5 V
At 12.5 MHz oscillation frequency ............................ 4.0 to 5.5 V
At 8.38 MHz oscillation frequency) ........................ 2.7 to 5.5 V ✽
In low-speed mode
At 32 kHz oscillation frequency .............................. 2.7 to 5.5 V ✽
(✽ This value of flash memory version is 4.0 to 5.5 V.)
●Power dissipation
In high-speed mode ................................................ 60 mW (typ.)
(at 16.8 MHz oscillation frequency, at 5 V power source voltage)
In low-speed mode ................................................... 60 µW (typ.)
(at 32 kHz oscillation frequency, at 3 V power source voltage)
●Operating temperature range .................................... –20 to 85°C
●Packages
SP .................................................. 64P4B (64-pin 750 mil SDIP)
FP ....................................... 64P6N-A (64-pin 14 ✕ 14 mm QFP)
HP ..................................... 64P6Q-A (64-pin 10 ✕ 10 mm LQFP)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 1 of 136
REJ03B0073-0401Z
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
<Flash memory mode>
●Supply voltage ................................................. VCC = 5 V ± 10 %
●Program/Erase voltage ........................... VPP = 11.7 V to 12.6 V
●Programming method ...................... Programming in unit of byte
●Erasing method
Batch erasing ........................................ Parallel/Serial I/O mode
Block erasing .................................... CPU reprogramming mode
●Program/Erase control by software command
●Number of times for programming/erasing ............................ 100
● Operating temperature range (at programming/erasing) ...........
........................................................................ Room temperature
■Notes
1. The flash memory version cannot be used for application embedded in the MCU card.
2. Supply voltage Vcc of the flash memory version is 4.0 to 5.5
V.
3803/3804 Group
P11/INT01
P12
P13
P14
P15
P16
P17
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
P07/AN15
P10/INT41
40
P06/AN14
42
41
P04/AN12
P05/AN13
43
P03/AN11
45
44
P01/AN9
P02/AN10
46
P00/AN8
47
48
PIN CONFIGURATION (TOP VIEW)
P37/SRDY3
49
32
P20(LED0)
P36/SCLK3
50
31
P21(LED1)
P35/TXD3
51
30
P22(LED2)
P34/RXD3
52
29
P23(LED3)
P33
53
28
P24(LED4)
P32
54
27
P25(LED5)
P31/DA2
55
26
P26(LED6)
P30/DA1
56
25
P27(LED7)
VCC
57
24
VSS
VREF
58
23
XOUT
AVSS
59
22
XIN
P67/AN7
60
21
P40/INT40/XCOUT
P66/AN6
61
20
P41/INT00/XCIN
P65/AN5
62
19
RESET
P64/AN4
63
18
CNVSS VPP
P63/AN3
64
17
P42/INT1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
P62/AN2
P61/AN1
P60/AN0
P57/INT3
P56/PWM
P55/CNTR1
P54/CNTR0
P53/SRDY2
P52/SCLK2
P51/SOUT2
P50/SIN2
P47/SRDY1/CNTR2
P46/SCLK1
P45/TXD1
P44/RXD1
P43/INT2
M38039FFFP/HP
M38037M8-XXXFP/HP
: Flash memory version
Package type : 64P6N-A/64P6Q-A
Fig. 1 3803 group pin configuration
PIN CONFIGURATION (TOP VIEW)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
M38039FFSP
M38037M8-XXXSP
VCC
VREF
AVSS
P67/AN7
P66/AN6
P65/AN5
P64/AN4
P63/AN3
P62/AN2
P61/AN1
P60/AN0
P57/INT3
P56/PWM
P55/CNTR1
P54/CNTR0
P53/SRDY2
P52/SCLK2
P51/SOUT2
P50/SIN2
P47/SRDY1/CNTR2
P46/SCLK1
P45/TXD1
P44/RXD1
P43/INT2
P42/INT1
VPP CNVSS
RESET
P41/INT00/XCIN
P40/INT40/XCOUT
XIN
XOUT
VSS
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
Package type : 64P4B
Fig. 2 3803 group pin configuration
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 2 of 136
P30/DA1
P31/DA2
P32
P33
P34/RXD3
P35/TXD3
P36/SCLK3
P37/SRDY3
P00/AN8
P01/AN9
P02/AN10
P03/AN11
P04/AN12
P05/AN13
P06/AN14
P07/AN15
P10/INT41
P11/INT01
P12
P13
P14
P15
P16
P17
P20(LED0)
P21(LED1)
P22(LED2)
P23(LED3)
P24(LED4)
P25(LED5)
P26(LED6)
P27(LED7)
: Flash memory version
3803/3804 Group
P11/INT01
P12
P13
P14
P15
P16
P17
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
P06/AN14
P07/AN15
P05/AN13
42
P10/INT41
P04/AN12
43
40
P03/AN11
45
44
41
P01/AN9
P02/AN10
46
P00/AN8
47
48
PIN CONFIGURATION (TOP VIEW)
P37/SRDY3
49
32
P20(LED0)
P36/SCLK3
50
31
P21(LED1)
P35/TXD3
51
30
P22(LED2)
P34/RXD3
52
29
P23(LED3)
P33/SCL
53
28
P24(LED4)
P32/SDA
54
27
P25(LED5)
P31/DA2
55
26
P26(LED6)
P30/DA1
56
25
P27(LED7)
VCC
57
24
VSS
VREF
58
23
XOUT
AVSS
59
22
XIN
P67/AN7
60
21
P40/INT40/XCOUT
P66/AN6
61
20
P41/INT00/XCIN
P65/AN5
62
19
RESET
P64/AN4
63
18
CNVSS VPP
P63/AN3
64
17
P42/INT1
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
P55/CNTR1
P54/CNTR0
P53/SRDY2
P52/SCLK2
P51/SOUT2
P50/SIN2
P47/SRDY1/CNTR2
P46/SCLK1
P45/TXD1
P44/RXD1
P43/INT2
3
P60/AN0
P57/INT3
2
P61/AN1
P56/PWM
1
P62/AN2
M38049FFFP/HP
M38047M8-XXXFP/HP
: Flash memory version
Package type : 64P6N-A/64P6Q-A
Fig. 3 3804 group pin configuration
PIN CONFIGURATION (TOP VIEW)
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
M38049FFSP
M38047M8-XXXSP
VCC
VREF
AVSS
P67/AN7
P66/AN6
P65/AN5
P64/AN4
P63/AN3
P62/AN2
P61/AN1
P60/AN0
P57/INT3
P56/PWM
P55/CNTR1
P54/CNTR0
P53/SRDY2
P52/SCLK2
P51/SOUT2
P50/SIN2
P47/SRDY1/CNTR2
P46/SCLK1
P45/TXD1
P44/RXD1
P43/INT2
P42/INT1
VPP CNVSS
RESET
P41/INT00/XCIN
P40/INT40/XCOUT
XIN
XOUT
VSS
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
P30/DA1
P31/DA2
P32/SDA
P33/SCL
P34/RXD3
P35/TXD3
P36/SCLK3
P37/SRDY3
P00/AN8
P01/AN9
P02/AN10
P03/AN11
P04/AN12
P05/AN13
P06/AN14
P07/AN15
P10/INT41
P11/INT01
P12
P13
P14
P15
P16
P17
P20(LED0)
P21(LED1)
P22(LED2)
P23(LED3)
P24(LED4)
P25(LED5)
P26(LED6)
P27(LED7)
: Flash memory version
Package type : 64P4B
Fig. 4 3804 group pin configuration
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 3 of 136
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
28
29
Fig. 5 3803 group functional block diagram
page 4 of 136
3
VREF AVSS
2
A-D
converter
(10)
I/O port P6
4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
P6(8)
Clock generating circuit
31
ROM
INT3
PWM(8)
I/O port P5
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
P5(8)
SI/O2(8)
A
P4(8)
INT00
INT1
INT2
INT40
P3(8)
I/O port P4
27
I/O port P3
P2(8)
I/O port P2
(LED drive)
I/O port P1
I/O port P0
49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56
P0(8)
Timer Y (8)
Timer X (8)
Timer 2 (8)
Timer 1 (8)
INT01
INT41
41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48
P1(8)
Timer Z (16)
Prescaler Y (8)
Prescaler X (8)
Prescaler 12 (8)
CNTR2
CNTR1
26
CNVSS
33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
CNTR0
SI/O3(8)
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64
D-A
D-A
converter converter
2 (8)
1 (8)
PS
PC L
S
Y
X
20 21 22 23 24 25 28 29
SI/O1(8)
PC H
C P U
Data bus
1
32
RESET
30
Reset input
V CC
X IN X OUT X CIN X COUT
V SS
Clock Clock Sub-clock Sub-clock
input output input
output
RAM
FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM (Package: 64P4B)
3803/3804 Group
FUNCTIONAL BLOCK
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
28
29
Fig. 6 3804 group functional block diagram
page 5 of 136
VREF AVSS
2 3
A-D
converter
(10)
I/O port P6
4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
P6(8)
Clock generating circuit
31
INT3
PWM(8)
RAM
I/O port P5
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19
P5(8)
SI/O2(8)
ROM
A
P4(8)
INT00
INT1
INT2
INT40
P3(8)
I/O port P4
27
I/O port P3
P2(8)
I/O port P2
(LED drive)
P1(8)
I/O port P1
I/O port P0
49 50 51 52 53 54 55 56
P0(8)
Timer Y (8)
Timer X (8)
Timer 2 (8)
Timer 1 (8)
INT01
INT41
41 42 43 44 45 46 47 48
I 2C
Timer Z (16)
Prescaler Y (8)
Prescaler X (8)
Prescaler 12 (8)
CNTR2
CNTR1
26
CNVSS
33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
CNTR0
SI/O3(8)
57 58 59 60 61 62 63 64
D-A
D-A
converter converter
2 (8)
1 (8)
PS
PC L
S
Y
X
20 21 22 23 24 25 28 29
SI/O1(8)
PC H
C P U
Data bus
1
32
RESET
30
Reset input
V CC
X IN X OUT X CIN X COUT
V SS
Clock Clock Sub-clock Sub-clock
input output input
output
FUNCTIONAL BLOCK DIAGRAM (Package: 64P4B)
3803/3804 Group
3803/3804 Group
PIN DESCRIPTION
Table 1 Pin description (3803 group)
Pin
Functions
Name
VCC, VSS
Power source
CNVSS
CNVSS input
Function except a port function
•Apply voltage of 2.7 V – 5.5 V to Vcc, and 0 V to Vss.
•In the flash memory version, apply voltage of 4.0 V – 5.5 V to Vcc, and 0 V to Vss
•This pin controls the operation mode of the chip.
•Normally connected to VSS.
•In the flash memory version, this becomes VPP power source input pin.
VREF
AVSS
Reference voltage
Analog power source
•Reference voltage input pin for A-D and D-A converters.
RESET
XIN
Reset input
•Reset input pin for active “L”.
Clock input
•Input and output pins for the clock generating circuit.
•Analog power source input pin for A-D and D-A converters.
•Connect to VSS.
•Connect a ceramic resonator or quartz-crystal oscillator between the XIN and XOUT pins to set
the oscillation frequency.
XOUT
Clock output
P00/AN8–
P07/AN15
I/O port P0
•When an external clock is used, connect the clock source to the XIN pin and leave the XOUT
pin open.
•A-D converter input pin
•8-bit CMOS I/O port.
P10/INT41
I/O port P1
•I/O direction register allows each pin to be individually
•Interrupt input pin
programmed as either input or output.
P11/INT01
•CMOS compatible input level.
P12–P17
•CMOS 3-state output structure.
P20–P27
I/O port P2
P30/DA1
P31/DA2
I/O port P3
•Pull-up control is enabled in a bit unit.
•P20–P27 are enabled to output large current for LED drive.
•8-bit CMOS I/O port.
•D-A converter input pin
•I/O direction register allows each pin to be individually
programmed as either input or output.
P32, P33
P34/RxD3
•P30, P31, P34–P37 are CMOS 3-state output structure. •Serial I/O3 function pin
P35/TxD3
•P32, P33 are N-channel open-drain output structure.
P36/SCLK3
•Pull-up control of P30, P31, P34–P37 is enabled in a bit
unit.
P37/SRDY3
P40/INT40/
XCOUT
I/O port P4
P41/INT00/
XCIN
•8-bit CMOS I/O port.
•Interrupt input pin
•I/O direction register allows each pin to be individually
programmed as either input or output.
•Sub-clock generating I/O pin
(resonator connected)
•CMOS compatible input level.
P42/INT1
P43/INT2
•CMOS 3-state output structure.
•Interrupt input pin
•Pull-up control is enabled in a bit unit.
P44/RxD1
•Serial I/O1 function pin
P45/TxD1
P46/SCLK1
P47/SRDY1
/CNTR2
•Serial I/O1, timer Z function pin
I/O port P5
P50/SIN2
P51/SOUT2
•8-bit CMOS I/O port.
P52/SCLK2
P53/SRDY2
P54/CNTR0
•CMOS compatible input level.
P55/CNTR1
•Pull-up control is enabled in a bit unit.
•CMOS 3-state output structure.
P56/PWM
Rev.4.01
I/O port P6
Nov 14, 2003
•Timer X function pin
•Timer Y function pin
•PWM output pin
•Interrupt input pin
•A-D converter input pin
P57/INT3
P60/AN0–
P67/AN7
•Serial I/O2 function pin
•I/O direction register allows each pin to be individually
programmed as either input or output.
page 6 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Table 2 Pin description (3804 group)
Pin
Functions
Name
VCC, VSS
Power source
CNVSS
CNVSS input
Function except a port function
•Apply voltage of 2.7 V – 5.5 V to Vcc, and 0 V to Vss.
•In the flash memory version, apply voltage of 4.0 V – 5.5 V to Vcc, and 0 V to Vss
•This pin controls the operation mode of the chip.
•Normally connected to VSS.
•In the flash memory version, this becomes VPP power source input pin.
VREF
AVSS
Reference voltage
Analog power source
•Reference voltage input pin for A-D and D-A converters.
RESET
XIN
Reset input
•Reset input pin for active “L”.
Clock input
•Input and output pins for the clock generating circuit.
•Analog power source input pin for A-D and D-A converters.
•Connect to VSS.
•Connect a ceramic resonator or quartz-crystal oscillator between the XIN and XOUT pins to set
the oscillation frequency.
XOUT
Clock output
P00/AN8–
P07/AN15
I/O port P0
•When an external clock is used, connect the clock source to the XIN pin and leave the XOUT
pin open.
•A-D converter input pin
•8-bit CMOS I/O port.
P10/INT41
I/O port P1
•I/O direction register allows each pin to be individually
•Interrupt input pin
programmed as either input or output.
P11/INT01
•CMOS compatible input level.
P12–P17
P20–P27
I/O port P2
P30/DA1
I/O port P3
•CMOS 3-state output structure.
•Pull-up control is enabled in a bit unit.
•P20–P27 are enabled to output large current for LED drive.
•8-bit CMOS I/O port.
•D-A converter input pin
•I/O direction register allows each pin to be individually
programmed as either input or output.
P31/DA2
•I2C-BUS interface function pins
•P32 to P33 can be switched between CMOS compatible input level or SMBUS input level in the I2C-BUS
•Serial I/O3 function pin
interface function.
P32/SDA
P33/SCL
P34/RxD3
P35/TxD3
•P30, P31, P34–P37 are CMOS 3-state output structure.
P36/SCLK3
•P32, P33 are N-channel open-drain output structure.
P37/SRDY3
•Pull-up control of P30, P31, P34–P37 is enabled in a bit
unit.
P40/INT40/
XCOUT
I/O port P4
P41/INT00/
XCIN
•8-bit CMOS I/O port.
•Interrupt input pin
•I/O direction register allows each pin to be individually
programmed as either input or output.
•Sub-clock generating I/O pin
(resonator connected)
•CMOS compatible input level.
P42/INT1
P43/INT2
•CMOS 3-state output structure.
•Interrupt input pin
•Pull-up control is enabled in a bit unit.
•Serial I/O1 function pin
P44/RxD1
P45/TxD1
P46/SCLK1
•Serial I/O1, timer Z function pin
P47/SRDY1
/CNTR2
P50/SIN2
I/O port P5
P51/SOUT2
•8-bit CMOS I/O port.
•Serial I/O2 function pin
•I/O direction register allows each pin to be individually
programmed as either input or output.
P52/SCLK2
P53/SRDY2
P54/CNTR0
•CMOS compatible input level.
•CMOS 3-state output structure.
•Timer X function pin
P55/CNTR1
•Pull-up control is enabled in a bit unit.
•Timer Y function pin
•PWM output pin
•Interrupt input pin
P56/PWM
P57/INT3
P60/AN0–
P67/AN7
Rev.4.01
•A-D converter input pin
I/O port P6
Nov 14, 2003
page 7 of 136
3803/3804 Group
PART NUMBERING
Product name
M3803 7
M
8
–
XXX
SP
Package type
SP : 64P4B
FP : 64P6N-A
HP : 64P6Q-A
ROM number
Omitted in the flash memory version.
– : standard
Omitted in the flash memory version.
ROM size
1 : 4096 bytes
2 : 8192 bytes
9 : 36864 bytes
A : 40960 bytes
B : 45056 bytes
C : 49152 bytes
D : 53248 bytes
E : 57344 bytes
F : 61440 bytes
3 : 12288 bytes
4 : 16384 bytes
5 : 20480 bytes
6 : 24576 bytes
7 : 28672 bytes
8 : 32768 bytes
The first 128 bytes and the last 2 bytes of ROM are reserved areas ; they
cannot be used as a user’s ROM area.
However, they can be programmed or erased in the flash memory version,
so that the users can use them.
Memory type
M : Mask ROM version
F : Flash memory version
RAM size
0 : 192 bytes
1 : 256 bytes
2 : 384 bytes
5 : 768 bytes
6 : 896 bytes
3 : 512 bytes
8 : 1536 bytes
9 : 2048 bytes
4 : 640 bytes
Group
3803: 3803 group
3804: 3804 group
Fig. 7 Part numbering
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 8 of 136
7 : 1024 bytes
3803/3804 Group
GROUP EXPANSION
Packages
64P4B ......................................... 64-pin shrink plastic-molded DIP
64P6N-A .................................... 0.8 mm-pitch plastic molded QFP
64P6Q-A .................................. 0.5 mm-pitch plastic molded LQFP
GROUP EXPANSION
Renesas plans to expand the 3803/3804 group as follows.
Memory Type
Support for mask ROM and flash memory versions.
Memory Size
Flash memory size ......................................................... 60 K bytes
Mask ROM size ................................................. 16 K to 60 K bytes
RAM size ............................................................ 640 to 2048 bytes
Memory Expansion Plan
ROM size (bytes)
ROM
exteranal
As of Nov. 2003
: Mass production
60K
M38039MF, M38049MF
M38039FP, M38049FF
48K
M38039MC
M38049MC
M38037M8
M38047M8
32K
28K
M38037M6
M38047M6
24K
20K
M38034M4
M38044M4
16K
12K
8K
384
512
640
768
896
1024
1152
RAM size (bytes)
Fig. 8 Memory expansion plan
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 9 of 136
1280
1408
1536
2048
3072
4032
3803/3804 Group
Currently planning products are listed below.
As of Nov. 2003
Table 3 Support products
Product name
ROM size (bytes)
ROM size for User in ( )
RAM size (bytes)
Package
M38034M4-XXXSP
64P4B
M38034M4-XXXFP
64P6N-A
M38034M4-XXXHP
M38044M4-XXXSP
16384
(16254)
64P6Q-A
640
64P4B
M38044M4-XXXFP
64P6N-A
M38044M4-XXXHP
M38037M6-XXXSP
64P6Q-A
M38037M6-XXXFP
64P6N-A
64P6Q-A
M38037M6-XXXHP
M38047M6-XXXSP
24576
(24446)
1024
64P4B
64P6N-A
M38047M6-XXXHP
64P6Q-A
M38037M8-XXXSP
64P4B
M38037M8-XXXFP
64P6N-A
M38047M8-XXXSP
M38047M8-XXXFP
32768
(32638)
1024
64P6Q-A
64P4B
M38039MC-XXXSP
64P4B
M38039MC-XXXFP
64P6N-A
M38049MC-XXXSP
49152
(49022)
2048
64P6Q-A
64P4B
M38049MC-XXXFP
64P6N-A
M38049MC-XXXHP
64P6Q-A
M38039MF-XXXSP
64P4B
M38039MF-XXXFP
M38039MF-XXXHP
64P6N-A
M38049MF-XXXSP
61440
(61310)
2048
64P6Q-A
64P4B
M38049MF-XXXFP
64P6N-A
M38049MF-XXXHP
64P6Q-A
M38039FFSP
64P4B
M38039FFFP
64P6N-A
M38039FFHP
61440
M38049FFSP
2048
64P6Q-A
64P4B
M38049FFFP
64P6N-A
M38049FFHP
64P6Q-A
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
Mask ROM version
Mask ROM version
64P6N-A
64P6Q-A
M38047M8-XXXHP
M38039MC-XXXHP
Mask ROM version
64P4B
M38047M6-XXXFP
M38037M8-XXXHP
Remarks
page 10 of 136
Mask ROM version
Mask ROM version
Flash memory version
3803/3804 Group
FUNCTIONAL DESCRIPTION
CENTRAL PROCESSING UNIT (CPU)
[Stack Pointer (S)]
The 3803/3804 group uses the standard 740 Family instruction
set. Refer to the table of 740 Family addressing modes and machine instructions or the 740 Family Software Manual for details
on the instruction set.
Machine-resident 740 Family instructions are as follows:
The FST and SLW instructions cannot be used.
The STP, WIT, MUL, and DIV instructions can be used.
[Accumulator (A)]
The accumulator is an 8-bit register. Data operations such as data
transfer, etc., are executed mainly through the accumulator.
[Index Register X (X)]
The index register X is an 8-bit register. In the index addressing
modes, the value of the OPERAND is added to the contents of
register X and specifies the real address.
[Index Register Y (Y)]
The stack pointer is an 8-bit register used during subroutine calls
and interrupts. This register indicates start address of stored area
(stack) for storing registers during subroutine calls and interrupts.
The low-order 8 bits of the stack address are determined by the
contents of the stack pointer. The high-order 8 bits of the stack address are determined by the stack page selection bit. If the stack
page selection bit is “0” , the high-order 8 bits becomes “0016”. If
the stack page selection bit is “1”, the high-order 8 bits becomes
“0116”.
The operations of pushing register contents onto the stack and
popping them from the stack are shown in Figure 10.
Store registers other than those described in Figure 10 with program when the user needs them during interrupts or subroutine
calls.
[Program Counter (PC)]
The program counter is a 16-bit counter consisting of two 8-bit
registers PCH and PCL. It is used to indicate the address of the
next instruction to be executed.
The index register Y is an 8-bit register. In partial instruction, the
value of the OPERAND is added to the contents of register Y and
specifies the real address.
b0
b7
A
Accumulator
b0
b7
X
Index register X
b0
b7
Y
b7
Index register Y
b0
S
b15
b7
PCH
Stack pointer
b0
Program counter
PCL
b7
b0
N V T B D I Z C
Processor status register (PS)
Carry flag
Zero flag
Interrupt disable flag
Decimal mode flag
Break flag
Index X mode flag
Overflow flag
Negative flag
Fig.9 740 Family CPU register structure
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 11 of 136
3803/3804 Group
On-going Routine
Interrupt request
(Note)
M (S)
Execute JSR
Push return address
on stack
M (S)
(PCH)
(S)
(S) – 1
M (S)
(PCL)
(S)
(S)– 1
(S)
M (S)
(S)
M (S)
(S)
Subroutine
POP return
address from stack
(S) + 1
(PCL)
M (S)
(S)
(S) + 1
(PCH)
M (S)
(S) – 1
(PCL)
Push return address
on stack
(S) – 1
(PS)
Push contents of processor
status register on stack
(S) – 1
Interrupt
Service Routine
Execute RTS
(S)
(PCH)
I Flag is set from “0” to “1”
Fetch the jump vector
Execute RTI
Note: Condition for acceptance of an interrupt
(S)
(S) + 1
(PS)
M (S)
(S)
(S) + 1
(PCL)
M (S)
(S)
(S) + 1
(PCH)
M (S)
POP contents of
processor status
register from stack
POP return
address
from stack
Interrupt enable flag is “1”
Interrupt disable flag is “0”
Fig. 10 Register push and pop at interrupt generation and subroutine call
Table 4 Push and pop instructions of accumulator or processor status register
Push instruction to stack
Pop instruction from stack
Accumulator
PHA
PLA
Processor status register
PHP
PLP
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 12 of 136
3803/3804 Group
[Processor status register (PS)]
The processor status register is an 8-bit register consisting of 5
flags which indicate the status of the processor after an arithmetic
operation and 3 flags which decide MCU operation. Branch operations can be performed by testing the Carry (C) flag , Zero (Z) flag,
Overflow (V) flag, or the Negative (N) flag. In decimal mode, the Z,
V, N flags are not valid.
•Bit 0: Carry flag (C)
The C flag contains a carry or borrow generated by the arithmetic
logic unit (ALU) immediately after an arithmetic operation. It can
also be changed by a shift or rotate instruction.
•Bit 1: Zero flag (Z)
The Z flag is set if the result of an immediate arithmetic operation
or a data transfer is “0”, and cleared if the result is anything other
than “0”.
•Bit 2: Interrupt disable flag (I)
The I flag disables all interrupts except for the interrupt
generated by the BRK instruction.
Interrupts are disabled when the I flag is “1”.
•Bit 3: Decimal mode flag (D)
The D flag determines whether additions and subtractions are
executed in binary or decimal. Binary arithmetic is executed when
this flag is “0”; decimal arithmetic is executed when it is “1”.
Decimal correction is automatic in decimal mode. Only the ADC
and SBC instructions can be used for decimal arithmetic.
•Bit 4: Break flag (B)
The B flag is used to indicate that the current interrupt was
generated by the BRK instruction. The BRK flag in the processor
status register is always “0”. When the BRK instruction is used to
generate an interrupt, the processor status register is pushed
onto the stack with the break flag set to “1”.
•Bit 5: Index X mode flag (T)
When the T flag is “0”, arithmetic operations are performed
between accumulator and memory. When the T flag is “1”, direct
arithmetic operations and direct data transfers are enabled
between memory locations.
•Bit 6: Overflow flag (V)
The V flag is used during the addition or subtraction of one byte
of signed data. It is set if the result exceeds +127 to -128. When
the BIT instruction is executed, bit 6 of the memory location
operated on by the BIT instruction is stored in the overflow flag.
•Bit 7: Negative flag (N)
The N flag is set if the result of an arithmetic operation or data
transfer is negative. When the BIT instruction is executed, bit 7 of
the memory location operated on by the BIT instruction is stored
in the negative flag.
Table 5 Set and clear instructions of each bit of processor status register
C flag
Z flag
I flag
D flag
B flag
T flag
V flag
N flag
Set instruction
SEC
–
SEI
SED
–
SET
–
–
Clear instruction
CLC
–
CLI
CLD
–
CLT
CLV
–
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 13 of 136
3803/3804 Group
[CPU Mode Register (CPUM)] 003B16
The CPU mode register contains the stack page selection bit, etc.
The CPU mode register is allocated at address 003B16.
b7
b0
1
CPU mode register
(CPUM : address 003B16)
Processor mode bits
b1 b0
0 0 : Single-chip mode
0 1 :
1 0 : Not available
1 1 :
Stack page selection bit
0 : 0 page
1 : 1 page
Fix this bit to “1”.
Port XC switch bit
0 : I/O port function (stop oscillating)
1 : XCIN–XCOUT oscillating function
Main clock (XIN–XOUT) stop bit
0 : Oscillating
1 : Stopped
Main clock division ratio selection bits
b7 b6
0 0 : φ = f(XIN)/2 (high-speed mode)
0 1 : φ = f(XIN)/8 (middle-speed mode)
1 0 : φ = f(XCIN)/2 (low-speed mode)
1 1 : Not available
Fig.11 Structure of CPU mode register
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 14 of 136
3803/3804 Group
MISRG
(1) Bit 0 of address 001016: Oscillation stabilizing time set after STP instruction released bit
When the MCU stops the clock oscillation by the STP instruction
and the STP instruction has been released by an external interrupt
source, usually, the fixed values of Timer 1 and Prescaler 12
(Timer 1 = 0116, Prescaler 12 = FF16) are automatically reloaded
in order for the oscillation to stabilize. The user can inhibit the automatic setting by setting “1” to bit 0 of MISRG (address 001016).
However, by setting this bit to “1”, the previous values, set just before the STP instruction was executed, will remain in Timer 1 and
Prescaler 12. Therefore, you will need to set an appropriate value
to each register, in accordance with the oscillation stabilizing time,
before executing the STP instruction.
Figure 12 shows the structure of MISRG.
(2) Bits 1, 2, 3 of address 0010 16: Middle-speed Mode Automatic Switch Function
In order to switch the clock mode of an MCU which has a subclock, the following procedure is necessary:
set CPU mode register (003B16) --> start main clock oscillation -->
wait for oscillation stabilization --> switch to middle-speed mode
(or high-speed mode).
However, the 3803/3804 group has the built-in function which automatically switches from low to middle-speed mode either by the
SCL/SDA interrupt (only for the 3804 group) or by program.
b7
●Middle-speed mode automatic switch by SCL/SDA Interrupt
(only for 3804 group)
The SCL/SDA interrupt source enables an automatic switch when
the middle-speed mode automatic switch set bit (bit 1) of MISRG
(address 0010 16 ) is set to “1”. The conditions for an automatic
switch execution depend on the settings of bits 5 and 6 of the I2C
start/stop condition control register (address 001616). Bit 5 is the
SCL/SDA interrupt pin polarity selection bit and bit 6 is the SCL/
SDA interrupt pin selection bit. The main clock oscillation stabilizing time can also be selected by middle-speed mode automatic
switch wait time set bit (bit 2) of the MISRG.
●Middle-speed mode automatic switch by program
The middle-speed mode can also be automatically switched by
program while operating in low-speed mode. By setting the
middle-speed automatic switch start bit (bit 3) of MISRG (address
001016) to “1” in the condition that the middle-speed mode automatic switch set bit is “1” while operating in low-speed mode, the
MCU will automatically switch to middle-speed mode. In this case,
the oscillation stabilizing time of the main clock can be selected by
the middle-speed automatic switch wait time set bit (bit 2) of
MISRG (address 001016).
b0
MISRG
(MISRG : address 001016)
Oscillation stabilizing time set after STP instruction
released bit
0: Automatically set “0116” to Timer 1,
“FF16” to Prescaler 12
1: Automatically set disabled
Middle-speed mode automatic switch set bit
0: Not set automatically
1: Automatic switching enabled (Notes 1, 2)
Middle-speed mode automatic switch wait time set bit
0: 4.5 to 5.5 machine cycles
1: 6.5 to 7.5 machine cycles
Middle-speed mode automatic switch start bit
(Depending on program)
0: Invalid
1: Automatic switch start (Note 2)
Not used (return “0” when read)
(Do not write “1” to this bit)
Notes 1: During operation in low-speed mode, it is possible automatically to
switch to middle-speed mode owing to SCL/SDA interrupt. This is
valid only for the 3804 group.
2: When automatic switch to middle-speed mode from low-speed mode
occurs, the values of CPU mode register (3B16) change.
Fig.12 Structure of MISRG
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 15 of 136
3803/3804 Group
MEMORY
Special Function Register (SFR) Area
Zero Page
Access to this area with only 2 bytes is possible in the zero page
addressing mode.
The Special Function Register area in the zero page contains control registers such as I/O ports and timers.
Special Page
RAM
Access to this area with only 2 bytes is possible in the special
page addressing mode.
RAM is used for data storage and for stack area of subroutine
calls and interrupts.
ROM
The first 128 bytes and the last 2 bytes of ROM are reserved for
device testing and the rest is a user area for storing programs.
Interrupt Vector Area
The interrupt vector area contains reset and interrupt vectors.
RAM area
RAM size
(bytes)
Address
XXXX16
192
256
384
512
640
768
896
1024
1536
2048
00FF16
013F16
01BF16
023F16
02BF16
033F16
03BF16
043F16
063F16
083F16
000016
SFR area
Zero page
004016
010016
RAM
XXXX16
Not used
0FF016
0FFF16
SFR area
Not used
YYYY16
ROM area
Reserved ROM area
ROM size
(bytes)
Address
YYYY16
Address
ZZZZ16
4096
8192
12288
16384
20480
24576
28672
32768
36864
40960
45056
49152
53248
57344
61440
F00016
E00016
D00016
C00016
B00016
A00016
900016
800016
700016
600016
500016
400016
300016
200016
100016
F08016
E08016
D08016
C08016
B08016
A08016
908016
808016
708016
608016
508016
408016
308016
208016
108016
Fig. 13 Memory map diagram
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 16 of 136
(128 bytes)
ZZZZ16
ROM
FF0016
FFDC16
Interrupt vector area
FFFE16
FFFF16
Reserved ROM area
Special page
3803/3804 Group
000016
Port P0 (P0)
002016
Prescaler 12 (PRE12)
000116
Port P0 direction register (P0D)
002116
Timer 1 (T1)
000216
Port P1 (P1)
002216
Timer 2 (T2)
000316
Port P1 direction register (P1D)
002316
Timer XY mode register (TM)
000416
Port P2 (P2)
002416
Prescaler X (PREX)
000516
Port P2 direction register (P2D)
002516
Timer X (TX)
000616
Port P3 (P3)
002616
Prescaler Y (PREY)
000716
Port P3 direction register (P3D)
002716
Timer Y (TY)
000816
Port P4 (P4)
002816
Timer Z low-order (TZL)
000916
Port P4 direction register (P4D)
002916
Timer Z high-order (TZH)
000A16
Port P5 (P5)
002A16
Timer Z mode register (TZM)
000B16
Port P5 direction register (P5D)
002B16
PWM control register (PWMCON)
000C16
Port P6 (P6)
002C16
PWM prescaler (PREPWM)
000D16
Port P6 direction register (P6D)
002D16
PWM register (PWM)
000E16
Timer 12, X count source selection register (T12XCSS)
002E16
000F16
Timer Y, Z count source selection register (TYZCSS)
002F16
Baud rate generator 3 (BRG3)
001016
MISRG
003016
Transmit/Receive buffer register 3 (TB3/RB3)
001116
Reserved ✽
003116
Serial I/O3 status register (SIO3STS)
001216
Reserved ✽
003216
Serial I/O3 control register (SIO3CON)
001316
Reserved ✽
003316
UART3 control register (UART3CON)
001416
Reserved ✽
003416
AD/DA control register (ADCON)
001516
Reserved ✽
003516
A-D conversion register 1 (AD1)
001616
Reserved ✽
003616
D-A1 conversion register (DA1)
001716
Reserved ✽
003716
D-A2 conversion register (DA2)
001816
Transmit/Receive buffer register 1 (TB1/RB1)
003816
A-D conversion register 2 (AD2)
001916
Serial I/O1 status register (SIO1STS)
003916
Interrupt source selection register (INTSEL)
001A16
Serial I/O1 control register (SIO1CON)
003A16
Interrupt edge selection register (INTEDGE)
001B16
UART1 control register (UART1CON)
003B16
CPU mode register (CPUM)
001C16
Baud rate generator (BRG1)
003C16
Interrupt request register 1 (IREQ1)
001D16
Serial I/O2 control register (SIO2CON)
003D16
Interrupt request register 2 (IREQ2)
001E16
Watchdog timer control register (WDTCON)
003E16
Interrupt control register 1 (ICON1)
001F16
Serial I/O2 register (SIO2)
003F16
Interrupt control register 2 (ICON2)
0FF016
Port P0 pull-up control register (PULL0)
0FF116
Port P1 pull-up control register (PULL1)
0FF216
Port P2 pull-up control register (PULL2)
0FF316
Port P3 pull-up control register (PULL3)
0FF416
Port P4 pull-up control register (PULL4)
0FF516
Port P5 pull-up control register (PULL5)
0FF616
Port P6 pull-up control register (PULL6)
0FFE16
Flash memory control register (FCON)
0FFF16
Flash command register (FCMD)
✽ Reserved area: Do not write any data to this addresses,
because these areas are reserved.
Fig. 14 Memory map of 3803 group’s special function register (SFR)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 17 of 136
3803/3804 Group
000016
Port P0 (P0)
002016
Prescaler 12 (PRE12)
000116
Port P0 direction register (P0D)
002116
Timer 1 (T1)
000216
Port P1 (P1)
002216
Timer 2 (T2)
000316
Port P1 direction register (P1D)
002316
Timer XY mode register (TM)
000416
Port P2 (P2)
002416
Prescaler X (PREX)
000516
Port P2 direction register (P2D)
002516
Timer X (TX)
000616
Port P3 (P3)
002616
Prescaler Y (PREY)
000716
Port P3 direction register (P3D)
002716
Timer Y (TY)
000816
Port P4 (P4)
002816
Timer Z low-order (TZL)
000916
Port P4 direction register (P4D)
002916
Timer Z high-order (TZH)
000A16
Port P5 (P5)
002A16
Timer Z mode register (TZM)
000B16
Port P5 direction register (P5D)
002B16
PWM control register (PWMCON)
000C16
Port P6 (P6)
002C16
PWM prescaler (PREPWM)
000D16
Port P6 direction register (P6D)
002D16
PWM register (PWM)
000E16
Timer 12, X count source selection register (T12XCSS)
002E16
000F16
Timer Y, Z count source selection register (TYZCSS)
002F16
Baud rate generator 3 (BRG3)
001016
MISRG
003016
Transmit/Receive buffer register 3 (TB3/RB3)
001116
I2C data shift register (S0)
003116
Serial I/O3 status register (SIO3STS)
001216
I2C special mode status register (S3)
003216
Serial I/O3 control register (SIO3CON)
001316
I2C status register (S1)
003316
UART3 control register (UART3CON)
001416
I2C
control register (S1D)
003416
AD/DA control register (ADCON)
001516
I2C clock control register (S2)
003516
A-D conversion register 1 (AD1)
001616
I2C
003616
D-A1 conversion register (DA1)
001716
I2C special mode control register (S3D)
003716
D-A2 conversion register (DA2)
001816
Transmit/Receive buffer register 1 (TB1/RB1)
003816
A-D conversion register 2 (AD2)
001916
Serial I/O1 status register (SIO1STS)
003916
Interrupt source selection register (INTSEL)
001A16
Serial I/O1 control register (SIO1CON)
003A16
Interrupt edge selection register (INTEDGE)
001B16
UART1 control register (UART1CON)
003B16
CPU mode register (CPUM)
001C16
Baud rate generator (BRG1)
003C16
Interrupt request register 1 (IREQ1)
001D16
Serial I/O2 control register (SIO2CON)
003D16
Interrupt request register 2 (IREQ2)
001E16
Watchdog timer control register (WDTCON)
003E16
Interrupt control register 1 (ICON1)
Serial I/O2 register (SIO2)
003F16
Interrupt control register 2 (ICON2)
0FF016
Port P0 pull-up control register (PULL0)
0FF116
Port P1 pull-up control register (PULL1)
0FF216
Port P2 pull-up control register (PULL2)
0FF316
Port P3 pull-up control register (PULL3)
0FF416
Port P4 pull-up control register (PULL4)
0FF516
Port P5 pull-up control register (PULL5)
001F16
START/STOP condition control register (S2D)
0FF616
Port P6 pull-up control register (PULL6)
0FF716
I2C slave address register 0 (S0D0)
0FF816
I2C slave address register 1 (S0D1)
0FF916
I2C slave address register 2 (S0D2)
0FFE16
Flash memory control register (FCON)
0FFF16
Flash command register (FCMD)
Fig. 15 Memory map of 3804 group’s special function register (SFR)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 18 of 136
3803/3804 Group
I/O PORTS
The I/O ports have direction registers which determine the input/
output direction of each individual pin. Each bit in a direction register corresponds to one pin, and each pin can be set to be input
port or output port.
When “0” is written to the bit corresponding to a pin, that pin be-
comes an input pin. When “1” is written to that bit, that pin becomes an output pin.
If data is read from a pin which is set to output, the value of the
port output latch is read, not the value of the pin itself. Pins set to
input are floating. If a pin set to input is written to, only the port
output latch is written to and the pin remains floating.
Table 6 I/O port function of 3803 group
Pin
P00/AN8–P07/AN15
P10/INT41
P11/INT01
Name
I/O Structure
Port P0
Port P1
CMOS compatible input level
Non-Port Function
A-D converter input
CMOS 3-state output
External interrupt input
Related SFRs
Ref.No.
AD/DA control register
(1)
Interrupt edge selection
register
(2)
P12–P17
(3)
P20/LED0–
P27/LED7
Port P2
P30/DA1
Port P3
CMOS compatible input level
P31/DA2
CMOS 3-state output
P32
CMOS compatible input level
P33
N-channel open-drain output
P34/RxD3
CMOS compatible input level
CMOS 3-state output
P35/TxD3
P36/SCLK3
D-A converter output
AD/DA control register
(4)
(5)
Serial I/O3 function I/O
Serial I/O3 control
register
(6)
(7)
UART3 control register
(8)
Interrupt edge selection
register
(10)
(9)
P37/SRDY3
P40/INT40/XCIN
Port P4
P41/INT00/XCOUT
CMOS compatible input level
External interrupt input
CMOS 3-state output
Sub-clock generating
circuit
P42/INT1
External interrupt input
CPU mode register
Interrupt edge selection
register
Serial I/O1 function I/O
Serial I/O1 control
register
P43/INT2
P44/RxD1
P45/TxD1
P46/SCLK1
P47/SRDY1/CNTR2
Serial I/O1 function I/O
Timer Z function I/O
(11)
(2)
(6)
(7)
UART1 control register
(8)
Serial I/O1 control
register
(12)
Timer Z mode register
Port P5
P50/SIN2
P51/SOUT2
CMOS compatible input level
CMOS 3-state output
Serial I/O2 function I/O
Serial I/O2 control
register
(14)
(15)
P52/SCLK2
(16)
P53/SRDY2
P54/CNTR0
P55/CNTR1
P56/PWM
P57/INT3
P60/AN0–P67/AN7
Port P6
CMOS compatible input level
Timer X, Y function I/O
Timer XY mode register
(17)
PWM output
External interrupt input
PWM control register
Interrupt edge selection
register
(18)
A-D converter input
AD/DA control register
(1)
CMOS 3-state output
Notes 1: Refer to the applicable sections how to use double-function ports as function I/O ports.
2: Make sure that the input level at each pin is either 0 V or VCC during execution of the STP instruction.
When an input level is at an intermediate potential, a current will flow from VCC to VSS through the input-stage gate.
Rev.4.01
(13)
Nov 14, 2003
page 19 of 136
(2)
3803/3804 Group
Table 7 I/O port function of 3804 group
Name
Pin
P00/AN8–P07/AN15 Port P0
Port P1
P10/INT41
CMOS compatible input level
I/O Structure
Non-Port Function
A-D converter input
CMOS 3-state output
External interrupt input
P11/INT01
Related SFRs
Ref.No.
AD/DA control register
(1)
Interrupt edge selection
register
(2)
(3)
P12–P17
P20/LED0–
P27/LED7
Port P2
P30/DA1
Port P3
CMOS compatible input level
CMOS 3-state output
D-A converter output
AD/DA control register
(4)
P31/DA2
P32/SDA
CMOS compatible input level
(5)
N-channel open-drain output
I2C-BUS interface function I/O
I2C control register
P33/SCL
Serial I/O3 function I/O
Serial I/O3 control
register
(6)
UART3 control register
(8)
Interrupt edge selection
register
(10)
CMOS/SMBUS input level (when
selecting I2C-BUS interface function)
P34/RxD3
CMOS compatible input level
P35/TxD3
CMOS 3-state output
P36/SCLK3
(7)
(9)
P37/SRDY3
P40/INT00/XCIN
Port P4
P41/INT40/XCOUT
CMOS compatible input level
External interrupt input
CMOS 3-state output
Sub-clock generating
circuit
P42/INT1
(11)
CPU mode register
External interrupt input
Interrupt edge selection
register
(2)
Serial I/O1 function I/O
(6)
P45/TxD1
Serial I/O1 control
register
P46/SCLK1
UART1 control register
(8)
Serial I/O1 control
register
Timer Z mode register
(12)
Serial I/O2 control
register
(13)
P43/INT2
P44/RxD1
P47/SRDY1/CNTR2
Serial I/O1 function I/O
Timer Z function I/O
Port P5
P50/SIN2
CMOS compatible input level
Serial I/O2 function I/O
CMOS 3-state output
P51/SOUT2
P52/SCLK2
P53/SRDY2
(7)
(14)
(15)
(16)
Timer X, Y function I/O
Timer XY mode register
(17)
P56/PWM
PWM output
PWM control register
(18)
P57/INT3
External interrupt input
Interrupt edge selection
register
(2)
A-D converter input
AD/DA control register
(1)
P54/CNTR0
P55/CNTR1
P60/AN0–P67/AN7
Port P6
CMOS compatible input level
CMOS 3-state output
Notes 1: Refer to the applicable sections how to use double-function ports as function I/O ports.
2: Make sure that the input level at each pin is either 0 V or VCC during execution of the STP instruction.
When an input level is at an intermediate potential, a current will flow from VCC to VSS through the input-stage gate.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 20 of 136
3803/3804 Group
(1) Ports P0, P6
(2) Ports P10, P11, P42, P43, P57
Pull-up control bit
Pull-up control bit
Direction
register
Data bus
Direction
register
Port latch
Data bus
Port latch
A-D converter input
Analog input pin
selection bit
(3) Ports P12 to P17, P2
Interrupt input
(4) Ports P30, P31
Pull-up control bit
Pull-up control bit
Direction
register
Direction
register
Data bus
Port latch
Data bus
Port latch
D-A converter output
DA1 output enable (P30)
DA2 output enable (P31)
(6) Ports P34, P44
(5) Ports P32, P33
Pull-up control bit
Serial I/O enable bit
Receive enable bit
Direction
register
Data bus
Direction
register
Port latch
Data bus
Port latch
Serial I/O input
(7) Ports P35, P45
(8) Ports P36, P46
Pull-up control bit
Serial I/O synchronous clock
selection bit
Pull-up control bit
Serial I/O enable bit
P-channel output
disable bit
Serial I/O enable bit
Transmit enable bit
Serial I/O mode selection bit
Serial I/O enable bit
Direction
register
Direction
register
Data bus
Data bus
Port latch
Serial I/O output
Port latch
Serial I/O clock output
Serial I/O external clock input
Fig. 16 Port block diagram of 3803 group (1)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 21 of 136
3803/3804 Group
(10) Port P40
(9) Port P37
Pull-up control bit
Pull-up control bit
Serial I/O3 mode
selection bit
Serial I/O3 enable bit
SRDY3 output enable bit
Port XC switch bit
Direction
register
Direction
register
Data bus
Port latch
Data bus
Port latch
INT40 interrupt input
Serial I/O3 ready output
Oscillator
Port P41
Port XC switch bit
(11) Port P41
(12) Port P47
Pull-up control bit
Port XC switch bit
Pull-up control bit
Serial I/O1 mode selection bit
Serial I/O1 enable bit
SRDY1 output enable bit
Direction
register
Direction
register
Data bus
Timer Z operating
mode bits
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
Port latch
Data bus
Port latch
INT00 interrupt input
Sub-clock generating circuit input
Timer output
Serial I/O1 ready output
CNTR2 interrupt input
(14) Port P51
(13) Port P50
Pull-up control bit
Pull-up control bit
Serial I/O2 transmit completion signal
Serial I/O2 port selection bit
Direction
register
Data bus
Direction
register
Port latch
Data bus
Port latch
Serial I/O2 input
Serial I/O2 output
Fig. 17 Port block diagram of 3803 group (2)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 22 of 136
P-channel output
disable bit
3803/3804 Group
(15) Port P52
(16) Port P53
Pull-up control bit
Pull-up control bit
Serial I/O2 synchronous clock
selection bit
Serial I/O2 port selection bit
SRDY2 enable bit
Direction
register
Direction
register
Port latch
Data bus
Data bus
Port latch
Serial I/O2 ready output
Serial I/O2 clock output
Serial I/O2 external clock input
(17) Ports P54, P55
(18) Port P56
Pull-up control bit
Pull-up control bit
PWM output enable bit
Direction
register
Data bus
Direction
register
Data bus
Port latch
Pulse output mode
PWM output
Timer output
CNTR interrupt input
Fig. 18 Port block diagram of 3803 group (3)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
Port latch
page 23 of 136
3803/3804 Group
(1) Ports P0, P6
(2) Ports P10, P11, P42, P43, P57
Pull-up control bit
Pull-up control bit
Direction
register
Data bus
Direction
register
Port latch
Data bus
Port latch
A-D converter input
Analog input pin
selection bit
(3) Ports P12 to P17, P2
Interrupt input
(4) Ports P30, P31
Pull-up control bit
Pull-up control bit
Direction
register
Direction
register
Data bus
Data bus
Port latch
Port latch
D-A converter output
DA1 output enable (P30)
DA2 output enable (P31)
(6) Ports P34, P44
(5) Ports P32, P33
Pull-up control bit
I2C-BUS interface enable bit
Serial I/O enable bit
Receive enable bit
Direction
register
Data bus
Direction
register
Port latch
Data bus
SDA output
SCL output
Port latch
SDA input
SCL input
Serial I/O input
(7) Ports P35, P45
(8) Ports P36, P46
Pull-up control bit
Serial I/O synchronous clock
selection bit
Pull-up control bit
Serial I/O enable bit
P-channel output
disable bit
Serial I/O enable bit
Transmit enable bit
Serial I/O mode selection bit
Serial I/O enable bit
Direction
register
Direction
register
Data bus
Data bus
Port latch
Serial I/O output
Port latch
Serial I/O clock output
Serial I/O external clock input
Fig. 19 Port block diagram of 3804 group (1)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 24 of 136
3803/3804 Group
(10) Port P40
(9) Port P37
Pull-up control bit
Pull-up control bit
Serial I/O3 mode
selection bit
Serial I/O3 enable bit
SRDY3 output enable bit
Port XC switch bit
Direction
register
Direction
register
Data bus
Port latch
Data bus
Port latch
INT40 interrupt input
Serial I/O3 ready output
Oscillator
Port P41
Port XC switch bit
(11) Port P41
(12) Port P47
Pull-up control bit
Port XC switch bit
Pull-up control bit
Serial I/O1 mode selection bit
Direction
register
Data bus
Timer Z operating
mode bits
Bit 2
Bit 1
Bit 0
SRDY1 output enable bit
Serial I/O1 enable bit
Direction
register
Port latch
Data bus
Port latch
INT00 interrupt input
Sub-clock generating circuit input
Timer output
Serial I/O1 ready output
CNTR2 interrupt input
(14) Port P51
(13) Port P50
Pull-up control bit
Pull-up control bit
Serial I/O2 transmit completion signal
Serial I/O2 port selection bit
Direction
register
Data bus
Direction
register
Port latch
Data bus
Port latch
Serial I/O2 input
Serial I/O2 output
Fig. 20 Port block diagram of 3804 group (2)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 25 of 136
P-channel output
disable bit
3803/3804 Group
(15) Port P52
(16) Port P53
Pull-up control bit
Pull-up control bit
Serial I/O2 synchronous clock
selection bit
Serial I/O2 port selection bit
SRDY2 output enable bit
Direction
register
Direction
register
Port latch
Data bus
Data bus
Port latch
Serial I/O2 ready output
Serial I/O2 clock output
Serial I/O2 external clock input
(17) Ports P54, P55
(18) Port P56
Pull-up control bit
Pull-up control bit
PWM output enable bit
Direction
register
Data bus
Direction
register
Data bus
Port latch
Pulse output mode
PWM output
Timer output
CNTR interrupt input
Fig. 21 Port block diagram of 3804 group (3)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
Port latch
page 26 of 136
3803/3804 Group
b7
b0
Port P0 pull-up control register
(PULL0: address 0FF016)
P00 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P01 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P02 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P03 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P04 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P05 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P06 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P07 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
b7
Note: Pull-up control is valid when the corresponding bit
of the port direction register is “0” (input).
When that bit is “1” (output), pull-up cannot be set
to the port of which pull-up is selected.
b0
Port P1 pull-up control register
(PULL1: address 0FF116)
P10 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P11 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P12 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P13 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P14 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P15 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P16 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P17 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
Fig. 22 Structure of port pull-up control register (1)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 27 of 136
Note: Pull-up control is valid when the corresponding bit
of the port direction register is “0” (input).
When that bit is “1” (output), pull-up cannot be set
to the port of which pull-up is selected.
3803/3804 Group
b7
b0
Port P2 pull-up control register
(PULL2: address 0FF216)
P20 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P21 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P22 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P23 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P24 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P25 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P26 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P27 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
b7
Note: Pull-up control is valid when the corresponding bit
of the port direction register is “0” (input).
When that bit is “1” (output), pull-up cannot be set
to the port of which pull-up is selected.
b0
Port P3 pull-up control register
(PULL3: address 0FF316)
P30 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P31 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
Not used
(return “0” when read)
P34 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P35 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P36 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P37 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
Fig. 23 Structure of port pull-up control register (2)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 28 of 136
Note: Pull-up control is valid when the corresponding bit
of the port direction register is “0” (input).
When that bit is “1” (output), pull-up cannot be set
to the port of which pull-up is selected.
3803/3804 Group
b7
b0
Port P4 pull-up control register
(PULL4: address 0FF416)
P40 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P41 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P42 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P43 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P44 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P45 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P46 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P47 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
b7
Note: Pull-up control is valid when the corresponding bit
of the port direction register is “0” (input).
When that bit is “1” (output), pull-up cannot be set
to the port of which pull-up is selected.
b0
Port P5 pull-up control register
(PULL5: address 0FF516)
P50 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P51 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P52 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P53 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P54 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P55 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P56 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P57 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
Fig. 24 Structure of port pull-up control register (3)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 29 of 136
Note: Pull-up control is valid when the corresponding bit
of the port direction register is “0” (input).
When that bit is “1” (output), pull-up cannot be set
to the port of which pull-up is selected.
3803/3804 Group
b7
b0
Port P6 pull-up control register
(PULL6: address 0FF616)
P60 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P61 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P62 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P63 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P64 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P65 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P66 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
P67 pull-up control bit
0: No pull-up
1: Pull-up
Fig. 25 Structure of port pull-up control register (4)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 30 of 136
Note: Pull-up control is valid when the corresponding bit
of the port direction register is “0” (input).
When that bit is “1” (output), pull-up cannot be set
to the port of which pull-up is selected.
3803/3804 Group
INTERRUPTS
■ Notes
The 3803 group’s interrupts are a type of vector and occur by 16
sources among 21 sources: eight external, twelve internal, and
one software.
The 3804 group’s interrupts occur by 16 sources among 23
sources: nine external, thirteen internal, and one software.
When setting the followings, the interrupt request bit may be set to
“1”.
•When switching external interrupt active edge
Related register: Interrupt edge selection register (address 3A16)
Timer XY mode register (address 2316)
Timer Z mode register (address 2A16)
I2C start/stop condition control register
(address 1616) (3804 group only)
•When switching interrupt sources of an interrupt vector address
where two or more interrupt sources are allocated
Related register: Interrupt source selection register
(address 3916)
When not requiring for the interrupt occurrence synchronized with
these setting, take the following sequence.
➀Set the corresponding interrupt enable bit to “0” (disabled).
➁Set the interrupt edge select bit or the interrupt source select bit.
➂Set the corresponding interrupt request bit to “0” after 1 or more
instructions have been executed.
➃Set the corresponding interrupt enable bit to “1” (enabled).
Interrupt Control
Each interrupt is controlled by an interrupt request bit, an interrupt
enable bit, and the interrupt disable flag except for the software interrupt set by the BRK instruction. An interrupt occurs if the
corresponding interrupt request and enable bits are “1” and the interrupt disable flag is “0”.
Interrupt enable bits can be set or cleared by software.
Interrupt request bits can be cleared by software, but cannot be
set by software.
The reset and the BRK instruction cannot be disabled with any
flag or bit. The I (interrupt disable) flag disables all interrupts except the reset and the BRK instruction interrupt.
When several interrupt requests occur at the same time, the interrupts are received according to priority.
Interrupt Operation
By acceptance of an interrupt, the following operations are automatically performed:
1. The contents of the program counter and the processor status
register are automatically pushed onto the stack.
2. The interrupt disable flag is set and the corresponding interrupt
request bit is cleared.
3. The interrupt jump destination address is read from the vector
table into the program counter.
Interrupt Source Selection
Which of each combination of the following interrupt sources can
be selected by the interrupt source selection register (address
003916).
1. INT0 or Timer Z
2. Serial I/O1 transmission or SCL, SDA (for 3804 group)
3. CNTR0 or SCL, SDA (for 3804 group)
4. CNTR1 or Serial I/O3 reception
5. Serial I/O2 or Timer Z
6. INT2 or I2C (for 3804 group)
7. INT4 or CNTR2
8. A-D converter or serial I/O3 transmission
External Interrupt Pin Selection
The occurrence sources of the external interrupt INT 0 and INT4
can be selected from either input from INT00 and INT40 pin, or input from INT01 and INT41 pin by the INT0, INT4 interrupt switch bit
of interrupt edge selection register (bit 6 of address 003A16).
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 31 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Table 8 Interrupt vector addresses and priority of 3803 group
Interrupt Source
Priority
Vector Addresses (Note 1)
Low
High
FFFC16
FFFD16
Interrupt Request
Generating Conditions
Remarks
Reset (Note 2)
1
INT0
2
FFFB16
FFFA16
INT1
3
FFF916
FFF816
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of INT1 input
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
Serial I/O1
reception
4
FFF716
FFF616
At completion of serial I/O1 data
reception
Valid when serial I/O1 is selected
Serial I/O1
transmission
5
FFF516
FFF416
At completion of serial I/O1
transmission shift or when
transmission buffer is empty
Valid when serial I/O1 is selected
Timer X
6
FFF316
FFF216
At timer X underflow
Timer Y
7
FFF116
FFF016
At timer Y underflow
Timer 1
8
FFEF16
FFEE16
At timer 1 underflow
Timer 2
9
FFED16
FFEC16
At timer 2 underflow
CNTR0
10
FFEB16
FFEA16
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of CNTR0 input
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
CNTR1
11
FFE916
FFE816
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of CNTR1 input
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
At completion of serial I/O3 data
reception
Valid when serial I/O3 is selected
At completion of serial I/O2 data
transmission or reception
Valid when serial I/O2 is selected
Timer Z
At reset
Non-maskable
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of INT0 input
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
At timer Z underflow
Serial I/O3
reception
Serial I/O2
STP release timer underflow
12
FFE716
FFE616
INT2
13
FFE516
FFE416
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of INT2 input
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
INT3
14
FFE316
FFE216
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of INT3 input
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
INT4
15
FFE116
FFE016
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of INT4 input
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of CNTR2 input
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
Timer Z
At timer Z underflow
CNTR2
A-D converter
Serial I/O3
transmission
16
BRK instruction
17
FFDF16
FFDD16
FFDE16
FFDC16
At completion of A-D conversion
At completion of serial I/O3
transmission shift or when
transmission buffer is empty
Valid when serial I/O3 is selected
At BRK instruction execution
Non-maskable software interrupt
Notes 1: Vector addresses contain interrupt jump destination addresses.
2: Reset function in the same way as an interrupt with the highest priority.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 32 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Table 9 Interrupt vector addresses and priority of 3804 group
Interrupt Source
Priority
Vector Addresses (Note 1)
Low
High
FFFC16
FFFD16
Interrupt Request
Generating Conditions
Remarks
Reset (Note 2)
1
INT0
2
FFFB16
FFFA16
INT1
3
FFF916
FFF816
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of INT1 input
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
Serial I/O1
reception
4
FFF716
FFF616
At completion of serial I/O1 data
reception
Valid when serial I/O1 is selected
Serial I/O1
transmission
5
FFF516
FFF416
At completion of serial I/O1
transmission shift or when
transmission buffer is empty
Valid when serial I/O1 is selected
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of SCL or SDA
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
Timer Z
At reset
Non-maskable
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of INT0 input
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
At timer Z underflow
SCL, SDA
Timer X
Timer Y
6
FFF316
FFF216
At timer X underflow
7
FFF116
FFF016
At timer Y underflow
Timer 1
8
FFEF16
FFEE16
At timer 1 underflow
Timer 2
9
FFED16
At timer 2 underflow
CNTR0
10
FFEB16
FFEC16
FFEA16
SCL, SDA
11
CNTR1
Serial I/O3
reception
Serial I/O2
FFE916
FFE816
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of CNTR0 input
STP release timer underflow
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of SCL or SDA
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of CNTR1 input
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
At completion of serial I/O3 data
reception
Valid when serial I/O3 is selected
At completion of serial I/O2 data
transmission or reception
Valid when serial I/O2 is selected
12
FFE716
FFE616
13
FFE516
FFE416
INT3
14
FFE316
FFE216
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of INT3 input
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
INT4
15
FFE116
FFE016
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of INT4 input
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of CNTR2 input
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
Timer Z
At timer Z underflow
INT2
I 2C
At detection of either rising or
falling edge of INT2 input
At completion of data transfer
CNTR2
A-D converter
16
FFDF16
FFDE16
Serial I/O3
transmission
BRK instruction
17
FFDD16
FFDC16
At completion of A-D conversion
At completion of serial I/O3
transmission shift or when
transmission buffer is empty
Valid when serial I/O3 is selected
At BRK instruction execution
Non-maskable software interrupt
Notes 1: Vector addresses contain interrupt jump destination addresses.
2: Reset function in the same way as an interrupt with the highest priority.
Rev.4.01
External interrupt
(active edge selectable)
Nov 14, 2003
page 33 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Interrupt request bit
Interrupt enable bit
Interrupt disable flag (I)
BRK instruction
Reset
Fig. 26 Interrupt control
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 34 of 136
Interrupt request
3803/3804 Group
b7
b0
Interrupt edge selection register
(INTEDGE : address 003A16)
INT0 active edge selection bit
INT1 active edge selection bit
Not used (returns “0” when read)
INT2 active edge selection bit
INT3 active edge selection bit
INT4 active edge selection bit
INT0, INT4 interrupt switch bit
0 : INT00, INT40 interrupt
1 : INT01, INT41 interrupt
Not used (returns “0” when read)
b7
b0
0 : Falling edge active
1 : Rising edge active
0 : Falling edge active
1 : Rising edge active
Interrupt request register 1
(IREQ1 : address 003C16)
b7
b0
INT0/Timer Z interrupt request bit
INT1 interrupt request bit
Serial I/O1 receive interrupt request bit
Serial I/O1 transmit interrupt request bit
Timer X interrupt request bit
Timer Y interrupt request bit
Timer 1 interrupt request bit
Timer 2 interrupt request bit
Interrupt request register 2
(IREQ2 : address 003D16)
CNTR0 interrupt request bit
CNTR1/Serial I/O3 receive interrupt
request bit
Serial I/O2/Timer Z interrupt request bit
INT2 interrupt request bit
INT3 interrupt request bit
INT4/CNTR2 interrupt request bit
AD converter/Serial I/O3 transmit
interrupt request bit
Not used (returns “0” when read)
0 : No interrupt request issued
1 : Interrupt request issued
b7
b0
Interrupt control register 1
(ICON1 : address 003E16)
b7
b0
INT0/Timer Z interrupt enable bit
INT1 interrupt enable bit
Serial I/O1 receive interrupt enable bit
Serial I/O1 transmit interrupt enable bit
Timer X interrupt enable bit
Timer Y interrupt enable bit
Timer 1 interrupt enable bit
Timer 2 interrupt enable bit
Interrupt control register 2
(ICON2 : address 003F16)
CNTR0 interrupt enable bit
CNTR1/Serial I/O3 receive interrupt
enable bit
Serial I/O2/Timer Z interrupt enable bit
INT2 interrupt enable bit
INT3 interrupt enable bit
INT4/CNTR2 interrupt enable bit
AD converter/Serial I/O3 transmit
interrupt enable bit
Not used (returns “0” when read)
0 : Interrupts disabled
1 : Interrupts enabled
b7
b0
Interrupt source selection register
(INTSEL: address 003916)
INT0/Timer Z interrupt source selection bit
0 : INT0 interrupt
1 : Timer Z interrupt
Serial I/O2/Timer Z interrupt source selection bit
0 : Serial I/O2 interrupt
1 : Timer Z interrupt
Not used
(Do not write “1” to these bits.)
(Do not write “1” to these bits simultaneously.)
INT4/CNTR2 interrupt source selection bit
0 : INT4 interrupt
1 : CNTR2 interrupt
Not used
(Do not write “1” to this bit.)
CNTR1/Serial I/O3 receive interrupt source selection bit
0 : CNTR1 interrupt
1 : Serial I/O3 receive interrupt
AD converter/Serial I/O3 transmit interrupt source selection bit
0 : A-D converter interrupt
1 : Serial I/O3 transmit interrupt
Fig. 27 Structure of interrupt-related registers of 3803 group
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 35 of 136
3803/3804 Group
b7
b0
Interrupt edge selection register
(INTEDGE : address 003A16)
INT0 active edge selection bit
INT1 active edge selection bit
Not used (returns “0” when read)
INT2 active edge selection bit
INT3 active edge selection bit
INT4 active edge selection bit
INT0, INT4 interrupt switch bit
0 : INT00, INT40 interrupt
1 : INT01, INT41 interrupt
Not used (returns “0” when read)
b7
b0
0 : Falling edge active
1 : Rising edge active
0 : Falling edge active
1 : Rising edge active
Interrupt request register 1
(IREQ1 : address 003C16)
b7
INT0/Timer Z interrupt request bit
INT1 interrupt request bit
Serial I/O1 receive interrupt request bit
Serial I/O1 transmit/SCL, SDA interrupt
request bit
Timer X interrupt request bit
Timer Y interrupt request bit
Timer 1 interrupt request bit
Timer 2 interrupt request bit
b7
b0
Interrupt control register 1
(ICON1 : address 003E16)
INT0/Timer Z interrupt enable bit
INT1 interrupt enable bit
Serial I/O1 receive interrupt enable bit
Serial I/O1 transmit/SCL, SDA interrupt
enable bit
Timer X interrupt enable bit
Timer Y interrupt enable bit
Timer 1 interrupt enable bit
Timer 2 interrupt enable bit
b0
Interrupt request register 2
(IREQ2 : address 003D16)
CNTR0/SCL, SDA interrupt request bit
CNTR1/Serial I/O3 receive interrupt
request bit
Serial I/O2/Timer Z interrupt request bit
INT2/I2C interrupt request bit
INT3 interrupt request bit
INT4/CNTR2 interrupt request bit
AD converter/Serial I/O3 transmit
interrupt request bit
Not used (returns “0” when read)
0 : No interrupt request issued
1 : Interrupt request issued
b7
b0
Interrupt control register 2
(ICON2 : address 003F16)
CNTR0/SCL, SDA interrupt enable bit
CNTR1/Serial I/O3 receive interrupt
enable bit
Serial I/O2/Timer Z interrupt enable bit
INT2/I2C interrupt enable bit
INT3 interrupt enable bit
INT4/CNTR2 interrupt enable bit
AD converter/Serial I/O3 transmit
interrupt enable bit
Not used (returns “0” when read)
0 : Interrupts disabled
1 : Interrupts enabled
b7
b0
Interrupt source selection register
(INTSEL: address 003916)
INT0/Timer Z interrupt source selection bit
0 : INT0 interrupt
1 : Timer Z interrupt
(Do not write “1” to these bits simultaneously.)
Serial I/O2/Timer Z interrupt source selection bit
0 : Serial I/O2 interrupt
1 : Timer Z interrupt
Serial I/O1 transmit/SCL, SDA interrupt source selection bit
0 : Serial I/O1 transmit interrupt
1 : SCL, SDA interrupt
(Do not write “1” to these bits simultaneously.)
CNTR0/SCL, SDA interrupt source selection bit
0 : CNTR0 interrupt
1 : SCL, SDA interrupt
INT4/CNTR2 interrupt source selection bit
0 : INT4 interrupt
1 : CNTR2 interrupt
INT2/I2C interrupt source selection bit
0 : INT2 interrupt
1 : I2C interrupt
CNTR1/Serial I/O3 receive interrupt source selection bit
0 : CNTR1 interrupt
1 : Serial I/O3 receive interrupt
AD converter/Serial I/O3 transmit interrupt source selection bit
0 : A-D converter interrupt
1 : Serial I/O3 transmit interrupt
Fig. 28 Structure of interrupt-related registers of 3804 group
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 36 of 136
3803/3804 Group
TIMERS
●8-bit Timers
Timer X and Timer Y
The 3803/3804 group has four 8-bit timers: timer 1, timer 2, timer
X, and timer Y.
The timer 1 and timer 2 use one prescaler in common, and the
timer X and timer Y use each prescaler. Those are 8-bit
prescalers. Each of the timers and prescalers has a timer latch or
a prescaler latch.
The division ratio of each timer or prescaler is given by 1/(n + 1),
where n is the value in the corresponding timer or prescaler latch.
All timers are down-counters. When the timer reaches “0016”, an
underflow occurs at the next count pulse and the contents of the
corresponding timer latch are reloaded into the timer and the
count is continued. When the timer underflows, the interrupt request bit corresponding to that timer is set to “1”.
●Timer divider
The divider count source is switched by the main clock division
ratio selection bits of CPU mode register (bits 7 and 6 at address
003B 16). When these bits are “00” (high-speed mode) or “01”
(middle-speed mode), XIN is selected. When these bits are“10”
(low-speed mode), XCIN is selected.
●Prescaler 12
The prescaler 12 counts the output of the timer divider. The count
source is selected by the timer 12, X count source selection
register among 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64, 1/128, 1/256, 1/512,
1/1024 of f(XIN) or f(XCIN).
Timer 1 and Timer 2
The timer 1 and timer 2 counts the output of prescaler 12 and periodically set the interrupt request bit.
●Prescaler X and prescaler Y
The prescaler X and prescaler Y count the output of the timer
divider or f(XCIN). The count source is selected by the timer 12, X
count source selection register (address 000E16) and the timer Y,
Z count source selection register (address 000F 16) among 1/2,
1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64, 1/128, 1/256, 1/512, and 1/1024 of f(XIN)
or f(XCIN); and f(XCIN).
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 37 of 136
The timer X and timer Y can each select one of four operating
modes by setting the timer XY mode register (address 002316).
(1) Timer mode
●Mode selection
This mode can be selected by setting “00” to the timer X operating
mode bits (bits 1 and 0) and the timer Y operating mode bits (bits
5 and 4) of the timer XY mode register (address 002316).
●Explanation of operation
The timer count operation is started by setting “0” to the timer X
count stop bit (bit 3) and the timer Y count stop bit (bit 7) of the
timer XY mode register (address 002316).
When the timer reaches “00 16”, an underflow occurs at the next
count pulse and the contents of timer latch are reloaded into the
timer and the count is continued.
(2) Pulse output mode
●Mode selection
This mode can be selected by setting “01” to the timer X operating
mode bits (bits 1 and 0) and the timer Y operating mode bits (bits
5 and 4) of the timer XY mode register (address 002316).
●Explanation of operation
The operation is the same as the timer mode’s. Moreover the
pulse which is inverted each time the timer underflows is output
from CNTR 0/CNTR1 pin. When the CNTR0 active edge switch bit
(bit 2) and the CNTR1 active edge switch bit (bit 6) of the timer XY
mode register (address 002316) is “0”, the output starts with “H”
level. When it is “1”, the output starts with “L” level.
When the value of the CNTR 0/CNTR 1 active edge switch bit is
changed during pulse output, the output level of the CNTR 0 /
CNTR1 pin is inverted.
■Precautions
Set the double-function port of CNTR0/CNTR1 pin and port P54/
P55 to output in this mode.
3803/3804 Group
(3) Event counter mode
●Mode selection
This mode can be selected by setting “10” to the timer X operating
mode bits (bits 1 and 0) and the timer Y operating mode bits (bits
5 and 4) of the timer XY mode register (address 002316).
●Explanation of operation
The operation is the same as the timer mode’s except that the
timer counts signals input from the CNTR0 or CNTR 1 pin. The
valid edge for the count operation depends on the CNTR 0 active
edge switch bit (bit 2) or the CNTR1 active edge switch bit (bit 6)
of the timer XY mode register (address 002316). When it is “0”, the
rising edge is valid. When it is “1”, the falling edge is valid.
■Precautions
Set the double-function port of CNTR0/CNTR1 pin and port P54/
P55 to input in this mode.
(4) Pulse width measurement mode
●Mode selection
This mode can be selected by setting “11” to the timer X operating
mode bits (bits 1 and 0) and the timer Y operating mode bits (bits
5 and 4) of the timer XY mode register (address 002316).
●Explanation of operation
When the CNTR0 active edge switch bit (bit 2) or the CNTR1 active edge switch bit (bit 6) of the timer XY mode register (address
002316) is “1”, the timer counts during the term of one falling edge
of CNTR0/CNTR1 pin input until the next rising edge of input (“L”
term). When it is “0”, the timer counts during the term of one rising
edge input until the next falling edge input (“H” term).
■Precautions
Set the double-function port of CNTR0/CNTR1 pin and port P54/
P55 to input in this mode.
The count operation can be stopped by setting “1” to the timer X
count stop bit (bit 3) and the timer Y count stop bit (bit 7) of the
timer XY mode register (address 002316). The interrupt request bit
is set to “1” each time the timer underflows.
•Precautions when switching count source
When switching the count source by the timer 12, X and Y count
source selection bits, the value of timer count is altered in inconsiderable amount owing to generating of thin pulses on the count
input signals.
Therefore, select the timer count source before setting the value
to the prescaler and the timer.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 38 of 136
3803/3804 Group
“00”
“01”
XIN
(1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64, 1/128, 1/256, 1/512, 1/1024)
Divider
Clock for timer 12
Clock for timer Y
XCIN
Main clock
division ratio
selection bits
Count source
selection bit
Clock for timer X
“10”
Data bus
Prescaler X latch (8)
f(XCIN)
Pulse width
measurement
mode
Prescaler X (8)
CNTR0 active edge
switch bit
“0”
P54/CNTR0
Event
counter
mode
Timer X latch (8)
Timer mode
Pulse output mode
Timer X (8)
Timer X count stop bit
To CNTR0 interrupt
request bit
“1”
CNTR0 active
edge switch bit “1”
Port P54
direction register
To timer X interrupt
request bit
“0”
Port P54
latch
Q
Toggle flip-flop T
Q
R
Timer X latch write pulse
Pulse output mode
Pulse output mode
Data bus
Count source selection bit
Clock for timer Y
Prescaler Y latch (8)
Pulse width
measurement
mode
f(XCIN)
Prescaler Y (8)
CNTR1 active edge
switch bit
“0”
P55/CNTR1
Event
counter
mode
Timer Y latch (8)
Timer mode
Pulse output mode
Timer Y (8)
To timer Y interrupt
request bit
Timer Y count stop bit
To CNTR1 interrupt
request bit
“1”
CNTR1 active
edge switch bit “1”
Q
Toggle flip-flop T
Q
Port P55
direction register
Port P55
latch
“0”
R
Timer Y latch write pulse
Pulse output mode
Pulse output mode
Data bus
Prescaler 12 latch (8)
Clock for timer 12
Prescaler 12 (8)
Timer 1 latch (8)
Timer 2 latch (8)
Timer 1 (8)
Timer 2 (8)
To timer 2 interrupt
request bit
To timer 1 interrupt
request bit
Fig. 29 Block diagram of timer X, timer Y, timer 1, and timer 2
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 39 of 136
3803/3804 Group
b7
b0
Timer XY mode register
(TM : address 002316)
Timer X operating mode bits
b1 b0
0 0 : Timer mode
0 1 : Pulse output mode
1 0 : Event counter mode
1 1 : Pulse width measurement mode
CNTR0 active edge switch bit
0 : Interrupt at falling edge
Count at rising edge in event counter mode
1 : Interrupt at rising edge
Count at falling edge in event counter mode
Timer X count stop bit
0 : Count start
1 : Count stop
Timer Y operating mode bits
b5 b4
0 0 : Timer mode
0 1 : Pulse output mode
1 0 : Event counter mode
1 1 : Pulse width measurement mode
CNTR1 active edge switch bit
0 : Interrupt at falling edge
Count at rising edge in event counter mode
1 : Interrupt at rising edge
Count at falling edge in event counter mode
Timer Y count stop bit
0 : Count start
1 : Count stop
Fig. 30 Structure of timer XY mode register
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 40 of 136
3803/3804 Group
b7
b0
Timer 12, X count source selection register
(T12XCSS : address 000E16)
Timer 12 count source selection bits
b3b2b1b0
1010 :
0 0 0 0 : f(XIN)/2 or f(XCIN)/2
1011 :
0 0 0 1 : f(XIN)/4 or f(XCIN)/4
1100 :
0 0 1 0 : f(XIN)/8 or f(XCIN)/8
1101 :
0 0 1 1 : f(XIN)/16 or f(XCIN)/16
1110 :
0 1 0 0 : f(XIN)/32 or f(XCIN)/32
1111 :
0 1 0 1 : f(XIN)/64 or f(XCIN)/64
0 1 1 0 : f(XIN)/128 or f(XCIN)/128
0 1 1 1 : f(XIN)/256 or f(XCIN)/256
1 0 0 0 : f(XIN)/512 or f(XCIN)/512
1 0 0 1 : f(XIN)/1024 or f(XCIN)/1024
Timer X count source selection bits
b7b6b5b4
0 0 0 0 : f(XIN)/2 or f(XCIN)/2
0 0 0 1 : f(XIN)/4 or f(XCIN)/4
0 0 1 0 : f(XIN)/8 or f(XCIN)/8
0 0 1 1 : f(XIN)/16 or f(XCIN)/16
0 1 0 0 : f(XIN)/32 or f(XCIN)/32
0 1 0 1 : f(XIN)/64 or f(XCIN)/64
0 1 1 0 : f(XIN)/128 or f(XCIN)/128
0 1 1 1 : f(XIN)/256 or f(XCIN)/256
1 0 0 0 : f(XIN)/512 or f(XCIN)/512
1 0 0 1 : f(XIN)/1024 or f(XCIN)/1024
1 0 1 0 : f(XCIN)
b7
1011 :
1100 :
1101 :
1110 :
1111 :
Not used
Not used
b0
Timer Y, Z count source selection register
(TYZCSS : address 000F16)
Timer Y count source selection bits
b3b2b1b0
0 0 0 0 : f(XIN)/2 or f(XCIN)/2
1011 :
0 0 0 1 : f(XIN)/4 or f(XCIN)/4
1100 :
0 0 1 0 : f(XIN)/8 or f(XCIN)/8
1101 :
0 0 1 1 : f(XIN)/16 or f(XCIN)/16
1110 :
0 1 0 0 : f(XIN)/32 or f(XCIN)/32
1111 :
0 1 0 1 : f(XIN)/64 or f(XCIN)/64
0 1 1 0 : f(XIN)/128 or f(XCIN)/128
0 1 1 1 : f(XIN)/256 or f(XCIN)/256
1 0 0 0 : f(XIN)/512 or f(XCIN)/512
1 0 0 1 : f(XIN)/1024 or f(XCIN)/1024
1 0 1 0 : f(XCIN)
Timer Z count source selection bits
b7b6b5b4
0 0 0 0 : f(XIN)/2 or f(XCIN)/2
0 0 0 1 : f(XIN)/4 or f(XCIN)/4
0 0 1 0 : f(XIN)/8 or f(XCIN)/8
0 0 1 1 : f(XIN)/16 or f(XCIN)/16
0 1 0 0 : f(XIN)/32 or f(XCIN)/32
0 1 0 1 : f(XIN)/64 or f(XCIN)/64
0 1 1 0 : f(XIN)/128 or f(XCIN)/128
0 1 1 1 : f(XIN)/256 or f(XCIN)/256
1 0 0 0 : f(XIN)/512 or f(XCIN)/512
1 0 0 1 : f(XIN)/1024 or f(XCIN)/1024
1 0 1 0 : f(XCIN)
Fig. 31 Structure of timer 12, X and timer Y, Z count source selection registers
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 41 of 136
1011 :
1100 :
1101 :
1110 :
1111 :
Not used
Not used
3803/3804 Group
●16-bit Timers
(2) Event counter mode
The timer Z is a 16-bit timer. When the timer reaches “000016”, an
underflow occurs at the next count pulse and the corresponding
timer latch is reloaded into the timer and the count is continued.
When the timer underflows, the interrupt request bit corresponding
to the timer Z is set to “1”.
When reading/writing to the timer Z, perform reading/writing to
both the high-order byte and the low-order byte. When reading the
timer Z, read from the high-order byte first, followed by the low-order byte. Do not perform the writing to the timer Z between read
operation of the high-order byte and read operation of the low-order byte. When writing to the timer Z, write to the low-order byte
first, followed by the high-order byte. Do not perform the reading
to the timer Z between write operation of the low-order byte and
write operation of the high-order byte.
The timer Z can select the count source by the timer Z count
source selection bits of timer Y, Z count source selection register
(bits 7 to 4 at address 000F16).
Timer Z can select one of seven operating modes by setting the
timer Z mode register (address 002A16).
●Mode selection
This mode can be selected by setting “000” to the timer Z operating mode bits (bits 2 to 0) and setting “1” to the timer/event
counter mode switch bit (bit 7) of the timer Z mode register (address 002A16).
The valid edge for the count operation depends on the CNTR2 active edge switch bit (bit 5) of the timer Z mode register (address
002A16). When it is “0”, the rising edge is valid. When it is “1”, the
falling edge is valid.
●Interrupt
The interrupt at an underflow is the same as the timer mode’s.
●Explanation of operation
The operation is the same as the timer mode’s.
Set the double-function port of CNTR2 pin and port P47 to input in
this mode.
Figure 34 shows the timing chart of the timer/event counter mode.
(1) Timer mode
●Mode selection
This mode can be selected by setting “000” to the timer Z operating mode bits (bits 2 to 0) and setting “0” to the timer/event
counter mode switch bit (b7) of the timer Z mode register (address
002A16).
●Count source selection
In high- or middle-speed mode, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64, 1/
128, 1/256, 1/512 or 1/1024 of f(XIN); or f(XCIN) can be selected as
the count source.
In low-speed mode, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64, 1/128, 1/256, 1/
512 or 1/1024 of f(XCIN); or f(XCIN) can be selected as the count
source.
●Interrupt
When an underflow occurs, the INT0/timer Z interrupt request bit
(bit 0) of the interrupt request register 1 (address 003C16) is set to
“1”.
●Explanation of operation
During timer stop, usually write data to a latch and a timer at the
same time to set the timer value.
The timer count operation is started by setting “0” to the timer Z
count stop bit (bit 6) of the timer Z mode register (address
002A16).
When the timer reaches “000016”, an underflow occurs at the next
count pulse and the contents of timer latch are reloaded into the
timer and the count is continued.
When writing data to the timer during operation, the data is written
only into the latch. Then the new latch value is reloaded into the
timer at the next underflow.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 42 of 136
(3) Pulse output mode
●Mode selection
This mode can be selected by setting “001” to the timer Z operating mode bits (bits 2 to 0) and setting “0” to the timer/event
counter mode switch bit (b7) of the timer Z mode register (address
002A16).
●Count source selection
In high- or middle-speed mode, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64, 1/
128, 1/256, 1/512 or 1/1024 of f(XIN); or f(XCIN) can be selected as
the count source.
In low-speed mode, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64, 1/128, 1/256, 1/
512 or 1/1024 of f(XCIN); or f(XCIN) can be selected as the count
source.
●Interrupt
The interrupt at an underflow is the same as the timer mode’s.
●Explanation of operation
The operation is the same as the timer mode’s. Moreover the
pulse which is inverted each time the timer underflows is output
from CNTR2 pin. When the CNTR2 active edge switch bit (bit 5) of
the timer Z mode register (address 002A16) is “0”, the output starts
with “H” level. When it is “1”, the output starts with “L” level.
■Precautions
Set the double-function port of CNTR2 pin and port P47 to output
in this mode.
[During timer operation stop]
The output from CNTR2 pin is initialized to the level depending on
CNTR2 active edge switch bit by writing to the timer.
[During timer operation enabled]
When the value of the CNTR2 active edge switch bit is changed,
the output level of CNTR2 pin is inverted.
Figure 35 shows the timing chart of the pulse output mode.
3803/3804 Group
(4) Pulse period measurement mode
(5) Pulse width measurement mode
●Mode selection
This mode can be selected by setting “010” to the timer Z operating mode bits (bits 2 to 0) and setting “0” to the timer/event
counter mode switch bit (b7) of the timer Z mode register (address
002A16).
●Count source selection
In high- or middle-speed mode, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64,
1/128, 1/256, 1/512 or 1/1024 of f(XIN); or f(XCIN) can be selected
as the count source.
In low-speed mode, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64, 1/128, 1/256,
1/512 or 1/1024 of f(XCIN); or f(XCIN) can be selected as the count
source.
●Interrupt
The interrupt at an underflow is the same as the timer mode’s.
When the pulse period measurement is completed, the INT 4 /
CNTR2 interrupt request bit (bit 5) of the interrupt request register
2 (address 003D16) is set to “1”.
●Explanation of operation
The cycle of the pulse which is input from the CNTR2 pin is measured. When the CNTR2 active edge switch bit (bit 5) of the timer
Z mode register (address 002A16) is “0”, the timer counts during
the term from one falling edge of CNTR2 pin input to the next falling edge. When it is “1”, the timer counts during the term from one
rising edge input to the next rising edge input.
When the valid edge of measurement completion/start is detected,
the 1’s complement of the timer value is written to the timer latch
and “FFFF16” is set to the timer.
Furthermore when the timer underflows, the timer Z interrupt request occurs and “FFFF16” is set to the timer. When reading the
timer Z, the value of the timer latch (measured value) is read. The
measured value is retained until the next measurement completion.
■Precautions
Set the double-function port of CNTR2 pin and port P47 to input in
this mode.
A read-out of timer value is impossible in this mode. The timer can
be written to only during timer stop (no measurement of pulse period).
Since the timer latch in this mode is specialized for the read-out of
measured values, do not perform any write operation during measurement.
“FFFF16” is set to the timer when the timer underflows or when the
valid edge of measurement start/completion is detected. Consequently, the timer value at start of pulse period measurement
depends on the timer value just before measurement start.
Figure 36 shows the timing chart of the pulse period measurement
mode.
●Mode selection
This mode can be selected by setting “011” to the timer Z operating mode bits (bits 2 to 0) and setting “0” to the timer/event
counter mode switch bit (b7) of the timer Z mode register (address
002A16).
●Count source selection
In high- or middle-speed mode, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64,
1/128, 1/256, 1/512 or 1/1024 of f(XIN); or f(XCIN) can be selected
as the count source.
In low-speed mode, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64, 1/128, 1/256,
1/512 or 1/1024 of f(XCIN); or f(XCIN) can be selected as the count
source.
●Interrupt
The interrupt at an underflow is the same as the timer mode’s.
When the pulse widths measurement is completed, the INT 4 /
CNTR2 interrupt request bit (bit 5) of the interrupt request register
2 (address 003D16) is set to “1”.
●Explanation of operation
The pulse width which is input from the CNTR2 pin is measured.
When the CNTR2 active edge switch bit (bit 5) of the timer Z mode
register (address 002A16) is “0”, the timer counts during the term
from one rising edge input to the next falling edge input (“H” term).
When it is “1”, the timer counts during the term from one falling
edge of CNTR2 pin input to the next rising edge of input (“L” term).
When the valid edge of measurement completion is detected, the
1’s complement of the timer value is written to the timer latch and
“FFFF16” is set to the timer.
When the timer Z underflows, the timer Z interrupt occurs and
“FFFF16” is set to the timer Z. When reading the timer Z, the value
of the timer latch (measured value) is read. The measured value is
retained until the next measurement completion.
■Precautions
Set the double-function port of CNTR2 pin and port P47 to input in
this mode.
A read-out of timer value is impossible in this mode. The timer can
be written to only during timer stop (no measurement of pulse
widths).
Since the timer latch in this mode is specialized for the read-out of
measured values, do not perform any write operation during measurement.
“FFFF16” is set to the timer when the timer underflows or when the
valid edge of measurement start/completion is detected. Consequently, the timer value at start of pulse width measurement
depends on the timer value just before measurement start.
Figure 37 shows the timing chart of the pulse width measurement
mode.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 43 of 136
3803/3804 Group
(6) Programmable waveform generating mode
●Mode selection
This mode can be selected by setting “100” to the timer Z operating mode bits (bits 2 to 0) and setting “0” to the timer/event
counter mode switch bit (b7) of the timer Z mode register (address
002A16).
●Count source selection
In high- or middle-speed mode, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64,
1/128, 1/256, 1/512 or 1/1024 of f(XIN); or f(XCIN) can be selected
as the count source.
In low-speed mode, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64, 1/128, 1/256, 1/
512 or 1/1024 of f(XCIN); or f(XCIN) can be selected as the count
source.
●Interrupt
The interrupt at an underflow is the same as the timer mode’s.
●Explanation of operation
The operation is the same as the timer mode’s. Moreover the
timer outputs the data set in the output level latch (bit 4) of the
timer Z mode register (address 002A16) from the CNTR2 pin each
time the timer underflows.
Changing the value of the output level latch and the timer latch after an underflow makes it possible to output an optional waveform
from the CNTR2 pin.
■Precautions
Set the double-function port of CNTR2 pin and port P47 to output
in this mode.
Figure 38 shows the timing chart of the programmable waveform
generating mode.
(7) Programmable one-shot generating mode
●Mode selection
This mode can be selected by setting “101” to the timer Z operating mode bits (bits 2 to 0) and setting “0” to the timer/event
counter mode switch bit (b7) of the timer Z mode register (address
002A16).
●Count source selection
In high- or middle-speed mode, 1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64, 1/
128, 1/256, 1/512 or 1/1024 of f(XIN); or f(XCIN) can be selected as
the count source.
●Interrupt
The interrupt at an underflow is the same as the timer mode’s.
The trigger to generate one-shot pulse can be selected by the
INT1 active edge selection bit (bit 1) of the interrupt edge selection
register (address 003A16). When it is “0”, the falling edge active is
selected; when it is “1”, the rising edge active is selected.
When the valid edge of the INT1 pin is detected, the INT1 interrupt
request bit (bit 1) of the interrupt request register 1 (address
003C16) is set to “1”.
●Explanation of operation
•“H” one-shot pulse; Bit 5 of timer Z mode register = “0”
The output level of the CNTR2 pin is initialized to “L” at mode selection. When trigger generation (input signal to INT 1 pin) is
detected, “H” is output from the CNTR2 pin. When an underflow
occurs, “L” is output. The “H” one-shot pulse width is set by the
setting value to the timer Z register low-order and high-order.
When trigger generating is detected during timer count stop, al-
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 44 of 136
though “H” is output from the CNTR2 pin, “H” output state continues because an underflow does not occur.
•“L” one-shot pulse; Bit 5 of timer Z mode register = “1”
The output level of the CNTR2 pin is initialized to “H” at mode selection. When trigger generation (input signal to INT 1 pin) is
detected, “L” is output from the CNTR 2 pin. When an underflow
occurs, “H” is output. The “L” one-shot pulse width is set by the
setting value to the timer Z low-order and high-order. When trigger
generating is detected during timer count stop, although “L” is output from the CNTR 2 pin, “L” output state continues because an
underflow does not occur.
■Precautions
Set the double-function port of CNTR2 pin and port P47 to output,
and of INT1 pin and port P42 to input in this mode.
This mode cannot be used in low-speed mode.
If the value of the CNTR2 active edge switch bit is changed during
one-shot generating enabled or generating one-shot pulse, then
the output level from CNTR2 pin changes.
Figure 39 shows the timing chart of the programmable one-shot
generating mode.
■Notes regarding all modes
●Timer Z write control
Which write control can be selected by the timer Z write control bit
(bit 3) of the timer Z mode register (address 002A16), writing data
to both the latch and the timer at the same time or writing data
only to the latch.
When the operation “writing data only to the latch” is selected, the
value is set to the timer latch by writing data to the address of
timer Z and the timer is updated at next underflow. After reset release, the operation “writing data to both the latch and the timer at
the same time” is selected, and the value is set to both the latch
and the timer at the same time by writing data to the address of
timer Z.
In the case of writing data only to the latch, if writing data to the
latch and an underflow are performed almost at the same time,
the timer value may become undefined.
●Timer Z read control
A read-out of timer value is impossible in pulse period measurement mode and pulse width measurement mode. In the other
modes, a read-out of timer value is possible regardless of count
operating or stopped.
However, a read-out of timer latch value is impossible.
●Switch of interrupt active edge of CNTR2 and INT1
Each interrupt active edge depends on setting of the CNTR2 active edge switch bit and the INT1 active edge selection bit.
●Switch of count source
When switching the count source by the timer Z count source selection bits, the value of timer count is altered in inconsiderable
amount owing to generating of thin pulses on the count input signals.
Therefore, select the timer count source before setting the value
to the prescaler and the timer.
3803/3804 Group
CNTR2 active edge
Data bus
switch bit
Programmable one-shot
“1”
P42/INT1
Programmable one-shot
generating circuit
Programmable one-shot
generating mode
generating mode
“0”
To INT1 interrupt
request bit
Programmable waveform
generating mode
D
Output level latch
Q
T
Pulse output mode
CNTR2 active edge
switch bit
S
Q
T
“0”
Q
“1”
Pulse output mode
“001”
“100”
“101”
Timer Z operating
mode bits
Timer Z low-order latch
Timer Z high-order latch
Timer Z low-order
Timer Z high-order
Port P47
latch
To timer Z interrupt
request bit
Port P47
direction register
Pulse period measurement mode
Pulse width measurement mode
Edge detection circuit
“1”
“0”
CNTR2 active edge
switch bit
X IN
XCIN
Fig. 32 Block diagram of timer Z
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 45 of 136
Clock for timer Z
P47/CNTR2
To CNTR2 interrupt
request bit
“1”
f(XCIN)
“0”
Timer/Event
counter mode
switch bit
Timer Z count stop bit
Count source
Divider
selection bit
(1/2, 1/4, 1/8, 1/16, 1/32, 1/64, 1/128, 1/256, 1/512, 1/1024)
3803/3804 Group
b7
b0
Timer Z mode register
(TZM : address 002A16)
Timer Z operating mode bits
b2b1b0
0 0 0 : Timer/Event counter mode
0 0 1 : Pulse output mode
0 1 0 : Pulse period measurement mode
0 1 1 : Pulse width measurement mode
1 0 0 : Programmable waveform generating mode
1 0 1 : Programmable one-shot generating mode
1 1 0 : Not available
1 1 1 : Not available
Timer Z write control bit
0 : Writing data to both latch and timer simultaneously
1 : Writing data only to latch
Output level latch
0 : “L” output
1 : “H” output
CNTR2 active edge switch bit
0 : •Event counter mode: Count at rising edge
•Pulse output mode: Start outputting “H”
•Pulse period measurement mode: Measurement
between two falling edges
•Pulse width measurement mode: Measurement of
“H” term
•Programmable one-shot generating mode: After
start outputting “L”, “H” one-shot pulse generated
•Interrupt at falling edge
1 : •Event counter mode: Count at falling edge
•Pulse output mode: Start outputting “L”
•Pulse period measurement mode: Measurement
between two rising edges
•Pulse width measurement mode: Measurement of
“L” term
•Programmable one-shot generating mode: After
start outputting “H”, “L” one-shot pulse generated
•Interrupt at rising edge
Timer Z count stop bit
0 : Count start
1 : Count stop
Timer/Event counter mode switch bit (Note)
0 : Timer mode
1 : Event counter mode
Note: When selecting the modes except the timer/event
counter mode, set “0” to this bit.
Fig. 33 Structure of timer Z mode register
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 46 of 136
3803/3804 Group
FFFF16
TL
000016
TR
TR
TR
TL : Value set to timer latch
TR : Timer interrupt request
Fig. 34 Timing chart of timer/event counter mode
FFFF16
TL
000016
TR
TR
TR
TR
Waveform output
from CNTR2 pin
CNTR2
CNTR2
TL : Value set to timer latch
TR : Timer interrupt request
CNTR2 : CNTR2 interrupt request
(CNTR2 active edge switch bit = “0”; Falling edge active)
Fig. 35 Timing chart of pulse output mode
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 47 of 136
3803/3804 Group
000016
T3
T2
T1
FFFF16
TR
FFFF16 + T1
TR
T2
T3
FFFF16
Signal input from
CNTR2 pin
CNTR2 CNTR2
CNTR2
CNTR2
CNTR2 of rising edge active
TR : Timer interrupt request
CNTR2 : CNTR2 interrupt request
Fig. 36 Timing chart of pulse period measurement mode (Measuring term between two rising edges)
000016
T3
T2
T1
FFFF16
TR
Signal input from
CNTR2 pin
FFFF16 + T2
T3
T1
CNTR2
CNTR2
CNTR2
CNTR2 interrupt of rising edge active; Measurement of “L” width
TR : Timer interrupt request
CNTR2 : CNTR2 interrupt request
Fig. 37 Timing chart of pulse width measurement mode (Measuring “L” term)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 48 of 136
3803/3804 Group
FFFF16
T3
L
T2
T1
000016
Signal output
from CNTR2 pin
L
T3
T1
T2
TR
TR
TR
TR
CNTR2
CNTR2
L : Timer initial value
TR : Timer interrupt request
CNTR2 : CNTR2 interrupt request
(CNTR2 active edge switch bit = “0”; Falling edge active)
Fig. 38 Timing chart of programmable waveform generating mode
FFFF16
L
TR
Signal input from
INT1 pin
Signal output
from CNTR2 pin
L
TR
L
CNTR2
TR
L
CNTR2
L : One-shot pulse width
TR : Timer interrupt request
CNTR2 : CNTR2 interrupt request
(CNTR2 active edge switch bit = “0”; Falling edge active)
Fig. 39 Timing chart of programmable one-shot generating mode (“H” one-shot pulse generating)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 49 of 136
3803/3804 Group
(1) Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode
SERIAL I/O
Serial I/O1
Clock synchronous serial I/O1 mode can be selected by setting
the serial I/O1 mode selection bit of the serial I/O1 control register
(bit 6 of address 001A16) to “1”.
For clock synchronous serial I/O, the transmitter and the receiver
must use the same clock. If an internal clock is used, transfer is
started by a write signal to the transmit/receive buffer register.
Serial I/O1 can be used as either clock synchronous or asynchronous (UART) serial I/O. A dedicated timer is also provided for
baud rate generation.
Data bus
Serial I/O1 control register
Address 001816
Receive buffer register 1
P44/RXD1
Address 001A16
Receive buffer full flag (RBF)
Receive interrupt request (RI)
Receive shift register 1
Shift clock
Clock control circuit
P46/SCLK1
Serial I/O1 synchronous
clock selection bit
Frequency division ratio 1/(n+1)
Baud rate generator 1
1/4
BRG count source selection bit
f(XIN)
(f(XCIN) in low-speed mode)
1/4
P47/SRDY1
F/F
Address 001C16
Clock control circuit
Falling-edge detector
Shift clock
P45/TXD1
Transmit shift completion flag (TSC)
Transmit interrupt source selection bit
Transmit interrupt request (TI)
Transmit shift register 1
Transmit buffer register 1
Address 001816
Transmit buffer empty flag (TBE)
Serial I/O1 status register
Address 001916
Data bus
Fig. 40 Block diagram of clock synchronous serial I/O1
Transfer shift clock
(1/2 to 1/2048 of the internal
clock, or an external clock)
Serial output TxD1
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Serial input RxD1
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Receive enable signal SRDY1
Write pulse to receive/transmit
buffer register (address 001816)
TBE = 0
TBE = 1
TSC = 0
RBF = 1
TSC = 1
Overrun error (OE)
detection
Notes 1: As the transmit interrupt (TI), which can be selected, either when the transmit buffer has emptied (TBE=1) or after the
transmit shift operation has ended (TSC=1), by setting the transmit interrupt source selection bit (TIC) of the serial I/O1
control register.
2: If data is written to the transmit buffer register when TSC=0, the transmit clock is generated continuously and serial data
is output continuously from the TxD pin.
3: The receive interrupt (RI) is set when the receive buffer full flag (RBF) becomes “1” .
Fig. 41 Operation of clock synchronous serial I/O1
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 50 of 136
3803/3804 Group
(2) Asynchronous Serial I/O (UART) Mode
two buffers have the same address in a memory. Since the shift
register cannot be written to or read from directly, transmit data is
written to the transmit buffer register, and receive data is read
from the receive buffer register.
The transmit buffer register can also hold the next data to be
transmitted, and the receive buffer register can hold a character
while the next character is being received.
Clock asynchronous serial I/O mode (UART) can be selected by
clearing the serial I/O1 mode selection bit of the serial I/O1 control
register to “0”.
Eight serial data transfer formats can be selected, and the transfer
formats used by a transmitter and receiver must be identical.
The transmit and receive shift registers each have a buffer, but the
Data bus
Address 001816
Serial I/O1 control register Address 001A16
Receive buffer full flag (RBF)
Receive interrupt request (RI)
OE
Character length selection bit
ST detector
7 bits
Receive shift register 1
Receive buffer register 1
P44/RXD1
1/16
8 bits
PE FE
UART control register
Address 001B16
SP detector
Clock control circuit
Serial I/O1 synchronous clock selection bit
P46/SCLK1
BRG count source selection bit Frequency division ratio 1/(n+1)
f(XIN)
Baud rate generator
(f(XCIN) in low-speed mode)
Address 001C16
1/4
ST/SP/PA generator
Transmit shift completion flag (TSC)
1/16
P45/TXD1
Transmit interrupt source selection bit
Transmit interrupt request (TI)
Transmit shift register 1
Character length selection bit
Transmit buffer register 1
Address 001816
Transmit buffer empty flag (TBE)
Serial I/O1 status register Address 001916
Data bus
Fig. 42 Block diagram of UART serial I/O1
Transmit or receive clock
Transmit buffer write
signal
TBE=0
TSC=0
TBE=1
Serial output TXD1
TBE=0
TSC=1]
TBE=1
ST
D0
D1
SP
ST
D0
SP
D1
]
1 start bit
7 or 8 data bit
1 or 0 parity bit
1 or 2 stop bit (s)
Generated at 2nd bit in 2-stop-bit mode
Receive buffer read
signal
RBF=0
RBF=1
Serial input RXD1
ST
D0
D1
SP
RBF=1
ST
D0
D1
SP
Notes 1: Error flag detection occurs at the same time that the RBF flag becomes “1” (at 1st stop bit, during reception).
2: As the transmit interrupt (TI), when either the TBE or TSC flag becomes “1,” can be selected to occur depending on the setting of the transmit
interrupt source selection bit (TIC) of the serial I/O1 control register.
3: The receive interrupt (RI) is set when the RBF flag becomes “1.”
4: After data is written to the transmit buffer when TSC=1, 0.5 to 1.5 cycles of the data shift cycle are necessary until changing to TSC=0.
Fig. 43 Operation of UART serial I/O1
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 51 of 136
3803/3804 Group
[Serial I/O1 Control Register (SIO1CON)]
001A16
The serial I/O1 control register consists of eight control bits for the
serial I/O1 function.
[UART1 Control Register (UART1CON)]
001B16
The UART control register consists of four control bits (bits 0 to 3)
which are valid when asynchronous serial I/O is selected and set
the data format of an data transfer, and one bit (bit 4) which is always valid and sets the output structure of the P45/TXD1 pin.
[Serial I/O1 Status Register (SIO1STS)]
001916
The read-only serial I/O1 status register consists of seven flags
(bits 0 to 6) which indicate the operating status of the serial I/O1
function and various errors.
Three of the flags (bits 4 to 6) are valid only in UART mode.
The receive buffer full flag (bit 1) is cleared to “0” when the receive
buffer register is read.
If there is an error, it is detected at the same time that data is
transferred from the receive shift register to the receive buffer register, and the receive buffer full flag is set. A write to the serial I/O1
status register clears all the error flags OE, PE, FE, and SE (bit 3
to bit 6, respectively). Writing “0” to the serial I/O1 enable bit SIOE
(bit 7 of the serial I/O1 control register) also clears all the status
flags, including the error flags.
Bits 0 to 6 of the serial I/O1 status register are initialized to “0” at
reset, but if the transmit enable bit (bit 4) of the serial I/O1 control
register has been set to “1”, the transmit shift completion flag (bit
2) and the transmit buffer empty flag (bit 0) become “1”.
[Transmit Buffer Register 1/Receive Buffer
Register 1 (TB1/RB1)] 001816
The transmit buffer register 1 and the receive buffer register 1 are
located at the same address. The transmit buffer is write-only and
the receive buffer is read-only. If a character bit length is 7 bits, the
MSB of data stored in the receive buffer is “0”.
[Baud Rate Generator 1 (BRG1)] 001C16
The baud rate generator determines the baud rate for serial transfer.
The baud rate generator divides the frequency of the count source
by 1/(n + 1), where n is the value written to the baud rate generator.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 52 of 136
3803/3804 Group
b7
b0
Serial I/O1 status register
(SIO1STS : address 001916)
b7
Transmit buffer empty flag (TBE)
0: Buffer full
1: Buffer empty
Receive buffer full flag (RBF)
0: Buffer empty
1: Buffer full
Transmit shift completion flag (TSC)
0: Transmit shift in progress
1: Transmit shift completed
Overrun error flag (OE)
0: No error
1: Overrun error
Parity error flag (PE)
0: No error
1: Parity error
Framing error flag (FE)
0: No error
1: Framing error
Summing error flag (SE)
0: (OE) U (PE) U (FE)=0
1: (OE) U (PE) U (FE)=1
Not used (returns “1” when read)
b0
Serial I/O1 control register
(SIO1CON : address 001A16)
BRG count source selection bit (CSS)
0: f(XIN) (f(XCIN) in low-speed mode)
1: f(XIN)/4 (f(XCIN)/4 in low-speed mode)
Serial I/O1 synchronous clock selection bit (SCS)
0: BRG output divided by 4 when clock synchronous
serial I/O is selected, BRG output divided by 16
when UART is selected.
1: External clock input when clock synchronous serial
I/O is selected, external clock input divided by 16
when UART is selected.
SRDY1 output enable bit (SRDY)
0: P47 pin operates as normal I/O pin
1: P47 pin operates as SRDY1 output pin
Transmit interrupt source selection bit (TIC)
0: Interrupt when transmit buffer has emptied
1: Interrupt when transmit shift operation is completed
Transmit enable bit (TE)
0: Transmit disabled
1: Transmit enabled
Receive enable bit (RE)
0: Receive disabled
1: Receive enabled
Serial I/O1 mode selection bit (SIOM)
0: Clock asynchronous (UART) serial I/O
1: Clock synchronous serial I/O
Serial I/O1 enable bit (SIOE)
0: Serial I/O1 disabled
(pins P44 to P47 operate as normal I/O pins)
1: Serial I/O1 enabled
(pins P44 to P47 operate as serial I/O pins)
b7
b0
UART1 control register
(UARTCON : address 001B16)
Character length selection bit (CHAS)
0: 8 bits
1: 7 bits
Parity enable bit (PARE)
0: Parity checking disabled
1: Parity checking enabled
Parity selection bit (PARS)
0: Even parity
1: Odd parity
Stop bit length selection bit (STPS)
0: 1 stop bit
1: 2 stop bits
P45/TXD1 P-channel output disable bit (POFF)
0: CMOS output (in output mode)
1: N-channel open drain output (in output mode)
Not used (return “1” when read)
Fig. 44 Structure of serial I/O1 control registers
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 53 of 136
3803/3804 Group
■ Notes concerning serial I/O1
1. Notes when selecting clock synchronous serial I/O
1.1 Stop of transmission operation
● Note
Clear the serial I/O1 enable bit and the transmit enable bit to “0”
(serial I/O and transmit disabled).
2. Notes when selecting clock asynchronous serial I/O
2.1 Stop of transmission operation
● Note
Clear the transmit enable bit to “0” (transmit disabled). The transmission operation does not stop by clearing the serial I/O1 enable
bit to “0”.
● Reason
Since transmission is not stopped and the transmission circuit is
not initialized even if only the serial I/O1 enable bit is cleared to “0”
(serial I/O disabled), the internal transmission is running (in this
case, since pins TxD1, RxD1, SCLK1, and SRDY1 function as I/O
ports, the transmission data is not output). When data is written to
the transmit buffer register in this state, data starts to be shifted to
the transmit shift register. When the serial I/O1 enable bit is set to
“1” at this time, the data during internally shifting is output to the
TxD1 pin and an operation failure occurs.
● Reason
Since transmission is not stopped and the transmission circuit is
not initialized even if only the serial I/O1 enable bit is cleared to “0”
(serial I/O disabled), the internal transmission is running (in this
case, since pins TxD1, RxD1, SCLK1, and S RDY1 function as I/O
ports, the transmission data is not output). When data is written to
the transmit buffer register in this state, data starts to be shifted to
the transmit shift register. When the serial I/O1 enable bit is set to
“1” at this time, the data during internally shifting is output to the
TxD1 pin and an operation failure occurs.
1.2 Stop of receive operation
● Note
Clear the receive enable bit to “0” (receive disabled), or clear the
serial I/O1 enable bit to “0” (serial I/O disabled).
2.2 Stop of receive operation
● Note
Clear the receive enable bit to “0” (receive disabled).
1.3 Stop of transmit/receive operation
● Note
Clear both the transmit enable bit and receive enable bit to “0”
(transmit and receive disabled).
(when data is transmitted and received in the clock synchronous
serial I/O mode, any one of data transmission and reception cannot be stopped.)
● Reason
In the clock synchronous serial I/O mode, the same clock is used
for transmission and reception. If any one of transmission and reception is disabled, a bit error occurs because transmission and
reception cannot be synchronized.
In this mode, the clock circuit of the transmission circuit also operates for data reception. Accordingly, the transmission circuit does
not stop by clearing only the transmit enable bit to “0” (transmit
disabled). Also, the transmission circuit is not initialized by clearing the serial I/O1 enable bit to “0” (serial I/O disabled) (refer to
1.1).
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 54 of 136
2.3 Stop of transmit/receive operation
● Note 1 (only transmission operation is stopped)
Clear the transmit enable bit to “0” (transmit disabled). The transmission operation does not stop by clearing the serial I/O1 enable
bit to “0”.
● Reason
Since transmission is not stopped and the transmission circuit is
not initialized even if only the serial I/O1 enable bit is cleared to “0”
(serial I/O disabled), the internal transmission is running (in this
case, since pins TxD1, RxD1, SCLK1, and S RDY1 function as I/O
ports, the transmission data is not output). When data is written to
the transmit buffer register in this state, data starts to be shifted to
the transmit shift register. When the serial I/O1 enable bit is set to
“1” at this time, the data during internally shifting is output to the
TxD1 pin and an operation failure occurs.
● Note 2 (only receive operation is stopped)
Clear the receive enable bit to “0” (receive disabled).
3803/3804 Group
3. SRDY1 output of reception side
● Note
When signals are output from the SRDY1 pin on the reception side
by using an external clock in the clock synchronous serial I/O
mode, set all of the receive enable bit, the S RDY1 output enable
bit, and the transmit enable bit to “1” (transmit enabled).
4. Setting serial I/O1 control register again
● Note
Set the serial I/O1 control register again after the transmission and
the reception circuits are reset by clearing both the transmit enable bit and the receive enable bit to “0.”
Clear both the transmit enable bit
(TE) and the receive enable bit
(RE) to “0”
↓
Set the bits 0 to 3 and bit 6 of the
serial I/O control register
↓
Set both the transmit enable bit
Can be set with the
LDM instruction at the
same time
(TE) and the receive enable bit
(RE), or one of them to “1”
5. Data transmission control with referring to transmit shift
register completion flag
● Note
After the transmit data is written to the transmit buffer register, the
transmit shift register completion flag changes from “1” to “0” with
a delay of 0.5 to 1.5 shift clocks. When data transmission is controlled with referring to the flag after writing the data to the transmit
buffer register, note the delay.
6. Transmission control when external clock is selected
● Note
When an external clock is used as the synchronous clock for data
transmission, set the transmit enable bit to “1” at “H” of the SCLK1
input level. Also, write data to the transmit buffer register at “H” of
the SCLK1 input level.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 55 of 136
7. Transmit interrupt request when transmit enable bit is set
● Note
When using the transmit interrupt, take the following sequence.
➀ Set the serial I/O1 transmit interrupt enable bit to “0” (disabled).
➁ Set the transmit enable bit to “1”.
➂ Set the serial I/O1 transmit interrupt request bit to “0” after 1 or
more instruction has executed.
➃ Set the serial I/O1 transmit interrupt enable bit to “1” (enabled).
● Reason
When the transmit enable bit is set to “1”, the transmit buffer
empty flag and the transmit shift register shift completion flag are
also set to “1”. Therefore, regardless of selecting which timing for
the generating of transmit interrupts, the interrupt request is generated and the transmit interrupt request bit is set at this point.
3803/3804 Group
Serial I/O2
b7
b0
The serial I/O2 function can be used only for clock synchronous
serial I/O.
For clock synchronous serial I/O2, the transmitter and the receiver
must use the same clock. If the internal clock is used, transfer is
started by a write signal to the serial I/O2 register.
Serial I/O2 control register
(SIO2CON : address 001D16)
Internal synchronous clock selection bits
b2 b1 b0
0 0 0: f(XIN)/8 (f(XCIN)/8 in low-speed mode)
0 0 1: f(XIN)/16 (f(XCIN)/16 in low-speed mode)
0 1 0: f(XIN)/32 (f(XCIN)/32 in low-speed mode)
0 1 1: f(XIN)/64 (f(XCIN)/64 in low-speed mode)
1 1 0: f(XIN)/128 (f(XCIN)/128 in low-speed mode)
1 1 1: f(XIN)/256 (f(XCIN)/256 in low-speed mode)
[Serial I/O2 Control Register (SIO2CON)]
001D16
Serial I/O2 port selection bit
0: I/O port
1: SOUT2,SCLK2 signal output
The serial I/O2 control register contains eight bits which control
various serial I/O2 functions.
SRDY2 output enable bit
0: I/O port
1: SRDY2 signal output
Transfer direction selection bit
0: LSB first
1: MSB first
Serial I/O2 synchronous clock selection bit
0: External clock
1: Internal clock
P51/SOUT2 P-channel output disable bit
0: CMOS output (in output mode)
1: N-channel open drain output (in output mode)
Fig. 45 Structure of serial I/O2 control register
1/8
Internal synchronous
clock selection bits
Divider
1/16
f(XIN)
(f(XCIN) in low-speed mode)
Data bus
1/32
1/64
1/128
1/256
P53 latch
P53/SRDY2
Serial I/O2 synchronous
clock selection bit “1”
SRDY2
“1 ”
SRDY2 output enable bit
Synchronization
circuit
SCLK2
“0 ”
“0”
External clock
P52 latch
“0 ”
P52/SCLK2
“1”
Serial I/O2 port selection bit
Serial I/O counter 2 (3)
P51 latch
“0 ”
P51/SOUT2
“1 ”
Serial I/O2 port selection bit
Serial I/O2 register (8)
P50/SIN2
Address 001F16
Fig. 46 Block diagram of serial I/O2
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 56 of 136
Serial I/O2
interrupt request
3803/3804 Group
Transfer clock (Note 1)
Serial I/O2 register
write signal
(Note 2)
Serial I/O2 output SOUT2
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Serial I/O2 input SIN2
Receive enable signal SRDY2
Serial I/O2 interrupt request bit set
Notes 1: When the internal clock is selected as the transfer clock, the divide ratio of f(XIN), or f(XCIN) in low-speed mode, can be
selected by setting bits 0 to 2 of the serial I/O2 control register.
2: When the internal clock is selected as the transfer clock, the SOUT2 pin goes to high impedance after transfer completion.
Fig. 47 Timing of serial I/O2
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 57 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Serial I/O3
(1) Clock Synchronous Serial I/O Mode
Serial I/O3 can be used as either clock synchronous or asynchronous (UART) serial I/O. A dedicated timer is also provided for
baud rate generation.
Clock synchronous serial I/O3 mode can be selected by setting
the serial I/O3 mode selection bit of the serial I/O3 control register
(bit 6 of address 003216) to “1”.
For clock synchronous serial I/O, the transmitter and the receiver
must use the same clock. If an internal clock is used, transfer is
started by a write signal to the transmit/receive buffer register.
Data bus
Serial I/O3 control register
Address 003016
Receive buffer register 3
P34/RXD3
Address 003216
Receive buffer full flag (RBF)
Receive interrupt request (RI)
Receive shift register 3
Shift clock
Clock control circuit
P36/SCLK3
Serial I/O3 synchronous
clock selection bit
Frequency division ratio 1/(n+1)
Baud rate generator 3
1/4
BRG count source selection bit
f(XIN)
(f(XCIN) in low-speed mode)
1/4
P37/SRDY3
Address 002F16
Clock control circuit
Falling-edge detector
F/F
Shift clock
P35/TXD3
Transmit shift completion flag (TSC)
Transmit interrupt source selection bit
Transmit interrupt request (TI)
Transmit shift register 3
Transmit buffer register 3
Address 003016
Transmit buffer empty flag (TBE)
Serial I/O3 status register
Address 003116
Data bus
Fig. 48 Block diagram of clock synchronous serial I/O3
Transfer shift clock
(1/2 to 1/2048 of the internal
clock, or an external clock)
Serial output TxD3
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Serial input RxD3
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
Receive enable signal SRDY3
Write pulse to receive/transmit
buffer register (address 003016)
TBE = 0
TBE = 1
TSC = 0
RBF = 1
TSC = 1
Overrun error (OE)
detection
Notes 1: As the transmit interrupt (TI), which can be selected, either when the transmit buffer has emptied (TBE=1) or after the
transmit shift operation has ended (TSC=1), by setting the transmit interrupt source selection bit (TIC) of the serial I/O3
control register.
2: If data is written to the transmit buffer register when TSC=0, the transmit clock is generated continuously and serial data
is output continuously from the TxD pin.
3: The receive interrupt (RI) is set when the receive buffer full flag (RBF) becomes “1” .
Fig. 49 Operation of clock synchronous serial I/O3
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 58 of 136
3803/3804 Group
(2) Asynchronous Serial I/O (UART) Mode
two buffers have the same address in a memory. Since the shift
register cannot be written to or read from directly, transmit data is
written to the transmit buffer register, and receive data is read
from the receive buffer register.
The transmit buffer register can also hold the next data to be
transmitted, and the receive buffer register can hold a character
while the next character is being received.
Clock asynchronous serial I/O mode (UART) can be selected by
clearing the serial I/O3 mode selection bit of the serial I/O3 control
register to “0”.
Eight serial data transfer formats can be selected, and the transfer
formats used by a transmitter and receiver must be identical.
The transmit and receive shift registers each have a buffer, but the
Data bus
Serial I/O3 control register Address 003216
Address 003016
P34/RXD3
Receive buffer full flag (RBF)
Receive interrupt request (RI)
Receive buffer register 3
OE
Character length selection bit
ST detector
7 bits
Receive shift register 3
1/16
8 bits
PE FE
UART3 control register
SP detector
Address 003316
Clock control circuit
Serial I/O3 synchronous clock selection bit
P36/SCLK3
BRG count source selection bit Frequency division ratio 1/(n+1)
f(XIN)
Baud rate generator 3
(f(XCIN) in low-speed mode)
Address 002F16
1/4
ST/SP/PA generator
Transmit shift completion flag (TSC)
1/16
P35/TXD3
Transmit interrupt source selection bit
Transmit interrupt request (TI)
Transmit shift register 3
Character length selection bit
Transmit buffer empty flag (TBE)
Serial I/O3 status register Address 003116
Transmit buffer register 3
Address 003016
Data bus
Fig. 50 Block diagram of UART serial I/O3
Transmit or receive clock
Transmit buffer write
signal
TBE=0
TSC=0
TBE=1
Serial output TXD3
TBE=0
TSC=1]
TBE=1
ST
D0
D1
SP
ST
D0
SP
D1
]
1 start bit
7 or 8 data bit
1 or 0 parity bit
1 or 2 stop bit (s)
Generated at 2nd bit in 2-stop-bit mode
Receive buffer read
signal
RBF=0
RBF=1
Serial input RXD3
ST
D0
D1
SP
RBF=1
ST
D0
D1
SP
Notes 1: Error flag detection occurs at the same time that the RBF flag becomes “1” (at 1st stop bit, during reception).
2: As the transmit interrupt (TI), when either the TBE or TSC flag becomes “1,” can be selected to occur depending on the setting of the transmit
interrupt source selection bit (TIC) of the serial I/O3 control register.
3: The receive interrupt (RI) is set when the RBF flag becomes “1.”
4: After data is written to the transmit buffer when TSC=1, 0.5 to 1.5 cycles of the data shift cycle are necessary until changing to TSC=0.
Fig. 51 Operation of UART serial I/O3
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 59 of 136
3803/3804 Group
[Serial I/O3 Control Register (SIO3CON)]
003216
The serial I/O3 control register consists of eight control bits for the
serial I/O3 function.
[UART3 Control Register (UART3CON)]
003316
The UART control register consists of four control bits (bits 0 to 3)
which are valid when asynchronous serial I/O is selected and set
the data format of an data transfer, and one bit (bit 4) which is always valid and sets the output structure of the P35/TXD3 pin.
[Serial I/O3 Status Register (SIO3STS)] 003116
The read-only serial I/O3 status register consists of seven flags
(bits 0 to 6) which indicate the operating status of the serial I/O3
function and various errors.
Three of the flags (bits 4 to 6) are valid only in UART mode.
The receive buffer full flag (bit 1) is cleared to “0” when the receive
buffer register is read.
If there is an error, it is detected at the same time that data is
transferred from the receive shift register to the receive buffer register, and the receive buffer full flag is set. A write to the serial I/O3
status register clears all the error flags OE, PE, FE, and SE (bit 3
to bit 6, respectively). Writing “0” to the serial I/O3 enable bit SIOE
(bit 7 of the serial I/O3 control register) also clears all the status
flags, including the error flags.
Bits 0 to 6 of the serial I/O3 status register are initialized to “0” at
reset, but if the transmit enable bit (bit 4) of the serial I/O3 control
register has been set to “1”, the transmit shift completion flag (bit
2) and the transmit buffer empty flag (bit 0) become “1”.
[Transmit Buffer Register 3/Receive Buffer
Register 3 (TB3/RB3)] 003016
The transmit buffer register 3 and the receive buffer register 3 are
located at the same address. The transmit buffer is write-only and
the receive buffer is read-only. If a character bit length is 7 bits, the
MSB of data stored in the receive buffer is “0”.
[Baud Rate Generator 3 (BRG3)] 002F16
The baud rate generator determines the baud rate for serial transfer.
The baud rate generator divides the frequency of the count source
by 1/(n + 1), where n is the value written to the baud rate generator.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 60 of 136
3803/3804 Group
b7
b0
Serial I/O3 status register
(SIO3STS : address 003116)
b7
Transmit buffer empty flag (TBE)
0: Buffer full
1: Buffer empty
Receive buffer full flag (RBF)
0: Buffer empty
1: Buffer full
Transmit shift completion flag (TSC)
0: Transmit shift in progress
1: Transmit shift completed
Overrun error flag (OE)
0: No error
1: Overrun error
Parity error flag (PE)
0: No error
1: Parity error
Framing error flag (FE)
0: No error
1: Framing error
Summing error flag (SE)
0: (OE) U (PE) U (FE)=0
1: (OE) U (PE) U (FE)=1
Not used (returns “1” when read)
b0
Serial I/O3 control register
(SIO3CON : address 003216)
BRG count source selection bit (CSS)
0: f(XIN) (f(XCIN) in low-speed mode)
1: f(XIN)/4 (f(XCIN)/4 in low-speed mode)
Serial I/O3 synchronous clock selection bit (SCS)
0: BRG output divided by 4 when clock synchronous
serial I/O is selected, BRG output divided by 16
when UART is selected.
1: External clock input when clock synchronous serial
I/O is selected, external clock input divided by 16
when UART is selected.
SRDY3 output enable bit (SRDY)
0: P37 pin operates as normal I/O pin
1: P37 pin operates as SRDY3 output pin
Transmit interrupt source selection bit (TIC)
0: Interrupt when transmit buffer has emptied
1: Interrupt when transmit shift operation is completed
Transmit enable bit (TE)
0: Transmit disabled
1: Transmit enabled
Receive enable bit (RE)
0: Receive disabled
1: Receive enabled
Serial I/O3 mode selection bit (SIOM)
0: Clock asynchronous (UART) serial I/O
1: Clock synchronous serial I/O
Serial I/O3 enable bit (SIOE)
0: Serial I/O disabled
(pins P34 to P37 operate as normal I/O pins)
1: Serial I/O enabled
(pins P34 to P37 operate as serial I/O pins)
b7
b0
UART3 control register
(UART3CON : address 003316)
Character length selection bit (CHAS)
0: 8 bits
1: 7 bits
Parity enable bit (PARE)
0: Parity checking disabled
1: Parity checking enabled
Parity selection bit (PARS)
0: Even parity
1: Odd parity
Stop bit length selection bit (STPS)
0: 1 stop bit
1: 2 stop bits
P35/TXD3 P-channel output disable bit (POFF)
0: CMOS output (in output mode)
1: N-channel open drain output (in output mode)
Not used (return “1” when read)
Fig. 52 Structure of serial I/O3 control registers
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 61 of 136
3803/3804 Group
■ Notes concerning serial I/O3
1. Notes when selecting clock synchronous serial I/O
1.1 Stop of transmission operation
● Note
Clear the serial I/O3 enable bit and the transmit enable bit to “0”
(serial I/O and transmit disabled).
2. Notes when selecting clock asynchronous serial I/O
2.1 Stop of transmission operation
● Note
Clear the transmit enable bit to “0” (transmit disabled). The transmission operation does not stop by clearing the serial I/O3 enable
bit to “0”.
● Reason
Since transmission is not stopped and the transmission circuit is
not initialized even if only the serial I/O3 enable bit is cleared to “0”
(serial I/O disabled), the internal transmission is running (in this
case, since pins TxD3, RxD3, SCLK3, and S RDY3 function as I/O
ports, the transmission data is not output). When data is written to
the transmit buffer register in this state, data starts to be shifted to
the transmit shift register. When the serial I/O enable bit is set to
“1” at this time, the data during internally shifting is output to the
TxD3 pin and an operation failure occurs.
● Reason
Since transmission is not stopped and the transmission circuit is
not initialized even if only the serial I/O3 enable bit is cleared to “0”
(serial I/O disabled), the internal transmission is running (in this
case, since pins TxD3, RxD3, SCLK3, and S RDY3 function as I/O
ports, the transmission data is not output). When data is written to
the transmit buffer register in this state, data starts to be shifted to
the transmit shift register. When the serial I/O3 enable bit is set to
“1” at this time, the data during internally shifting is output to the
TxD3 pin and an operation failure occurs.
1.2 Stop of receive operation
● Note
Clear the receive enable bit to “0” (receive disabled), or clear the
serial I/O3 enable bit to “0” (serial I/O disabled).
2.2 Stop of receive operation
● Note
Clear the receive enable bit to “0” (receive disabled).
1.3 Stop of transmit/receive operation
● Note
Clear both the transmit enable bit and receive enable bit to “0”
(transmit and receive disabled).
(when data is transmitted and received in the clock synchronous
serial I/O mode, any one of data transmission and reception cannot be stopped.)
● Reason
In the clock synchronous serial I/O mode, the same clock is used
for transmission and reception. If any one of transmission and reception is disabled, a bit error occurs because transmission and
reception cannot be synchronized.
In this mode, the clock circuit of the transmission circuit also operates for data reception. Accordingly, the transmission circuit does
not stop by clearing only the transmit enable bit to “0” (transmit
disabled). Also, the transmission circuit is not initialized by clearing the serial I/O3 enable bit to “0” (serial I/O disabled) (refer to
1.1).
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 62 of 136
2.3 Stop of transmit/receive operation
● Note 1 (only transmission operation is stopped)
Clear the transmit enable bit to “0” (transmit disabled). The transmission operation does not stop by clearing the serial I/O3 enable
bit to “0”.
● Reason
Since transmission is not stopped and the transmission circuit is
not initialized even if only the serial I/O3 enable bit is cleared to “0”
(serial I/O disabled), the internal transmission is running (in this
case, since pins TxD3, RxD3, SCLK3, and S RDY3 function as I/O
ports, the transmission data is not output). When data is written to
the transmit buffer register in this state, data starts to be shifted to
the transmit shift register. When the serial I/O3 enable bit is set to
“1” at this time, the data during internally shifting is output to the
TxD3 pin and an operation failure occurs.
● Note 2 (only receive operation is stopped)
Clear the receive enable bit to “0” (receive disabled).
3803/3804 Group
3. SRDY3 output of reception side
● Note
When signals are output from the SRDY3 pin on the reception side
by using an external clock in the clock synchronous serial I/O
mode, set all of the receive enable bit, the S RDY3 output enable
bit, and the transmit enable bit to “1” (transmit enabled).
4. Setting serial I/O3 control register again
● Note
Set the serial I/O3 control register again after the transmission and
the reception circuits are reset by clearing both the transmit enable bit and the receive enable bit to “0.”
Clear both the transmit enable bit
(TE) and the receive enable bit
(RE) to “0”
↓
Set the bits 0 to 3 and bit 6 of the
serial I/O3 control register
↓
Set both the transmit enable bit
Can be set with the
LDM instruction at the
same time
(TE) and the receive enable bit
(RE), or one of them to “1”
5. Data transmission control with referring to transmit shift
register completion flag
● Note
After the transmit data is written to the transmit buffer register, the
transmit shift register completion flag changes from “1” to “0” with
a delay of 0.5 to 1.5 shift clocks. When data transmission is controlled with referring to the flag after writing the data to the transmit
buffer register, note the delay.
6. Transmission control when external clock is selected
● Note
When an external clock is used as the synchronous clock for data
transmission, set the transmit enable bit to “1” at “H” of the SCLK3
input level. Also, write data to the transmit buffer register at “H” of
the SCLK input level.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 63 of 136
7. Transmit interrupt request when transmit enable bit is set
● Note
When using the transmit interrupt, take the following sequence.
➀ Set the serial I/O3 transmit interrupt enable bit to “0” (disabled).
➁ Set the transmit enable bit to “1”.
➂ Set the serial I/O3 transmit interrupt request bit to “0” after 1 or
more instruction has executed.
➃ Set the serial I/O3 transmit interrupt enable bit to “1” (enabled).
● Reason
When the transmit enable bit is set to “1”, the transmit buffer
empty flag and the transmit shift register shift completion flag are
also set to “1”. Therefore, regardless of selecting which timing for
the generating of transmit interrupts, the interrupt request is generated and the transmit interrupt request bit is set at this point.
3803/3804 Group
PULSE WIDTH MODULATION (PWM)
PWM Operation
The 3803/3804 group has PWM functions with an 8-bit resolution,
based on a signal that is the clock input XIN or that clock input divided by 2 or the clock input XCIN or that clock input divided by 2
in low-speed mode.
When bit 0 (PWM enable bit) of the PWM control register is set to
“1”, operation starts by initializing the PWM output circuit, and
pulses are output starting at an “H”.
If the PWM register or PWM prescaler is updated during PWM
output, the pulses will change in the cycle after the one in which
the change was made.
Data Setting
The PWM output pin also functions as port P56. Set the PWM period by the PWM prescaler, and set the “H” term of output pulse by
the PWM register.
If the value in the PWM prescaler is n and the value in the PWM
register is m (where n = 0 to 255 and m = 0 to 255) :
PWM period = 255 ✕ (n+1) / f(XIN)
= 31.875 ✕ (n+1) µs (when f(XIN) = 8 MHz)
Output pulse “H” term = PWM period ✕ m / 255
= 0.125 ✕ (n+1) ✕ m µs
(when f(XIN) = 8 MHz)
31.875 ✕ m ✕(n+1)
µs
255
PWM output
T = [31.875 ✕ (n+1)] µs
m: Contents of PWM register
n : Contents of PWM prescaler
T : PWM period (when f(XIN) = 8 MHz, count source
is f(XIN))
Fig. 53 Timing of PWM period
Data bus
PWM
prescaler pre-latch
PWM
register pre-latch
Transfer control circuit
PWM
prescaler latch
PWM
register latch
PWM prescaler
PWM register
Count source
selection bit
“0”
XIN
Port P56
or
XCIN
1/2
“1”
Port P56 latch
PWM enable bit
Fig. 54 Block diagram of PWM function
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 64 of 136
3803/3804 Group
b7
b0
PWM control register
(PWMCON : address 002B16)
PWM function enable bit
0: PWM disabled
1: PWM enabled
Count source selection bit
0: f(XIN)
1: f(XIN)/2
Not used (return “0” when read)
Fig. 55 Structure of PWM control register
A
B
B = C
T2
T
C
PWM output
T
PWM register
write signal
T
T2
(Changes “H” term from “A” to “B”.)
PWM prescaler
write signal
(Changes PWM period from “T” to “T2”.)
When the contents of the PWM register or PWM prescaler have changed, the PWM
output will change from the next period after the change.
Fig. 56 PWM output timing when PWM register or PWM prescaler is changed
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 65 of 136
3803/3804 Group
A-D CONVERTER
[A-D Conversion Register 1, 2 (AD1, AD2)]
003516, 003816
The A-D conversion register is a read-only register that stores the
result of an A-D conversion. When reading this register during an
A-D conversion, the previous conversion result is read.
Bit 7 of the A-D conversion register 2 is the conversion mode selection bit. When this bit is set to “0,” the A-D converter becomes
the 10-bit A-D mode. When this bit is set to “1,” that becomes the
8-bit A-D mode. The conversion result of the 8-bit A-D mode is
stored in the A-D conversion register 1. As for 10-bit A-D mode,
not only 10-bit reading but also only high-order 8-bit reading of
conversion result can be performed by selecting the reading procedure of the A-D conversion registers 1, 2 after A-D conversion is
completed (in Figure 58).
As for 10-bit A-D mode, the 8-bit reading inclined to MSB is performed when reading the A-D converter register 1 after A-D
conversion is started; and when the A-D converter register 1 is
read after reading the A-D converter register 2, the 8-bit reading
inclined to LSB is performed.
Channel Selector
The channel selector selects one of ports P67/AN7 to P60/AN0 or
P07/AN15 to P00/AN8, and inputs the voltage to the comparator.
Comparator and Control Circuit
The comparator and control circuit compares an analog input voltage with the comparison voltage, and then stores the result in the
A-D conversion registers 1, 2. When an A-D conversion is completed, the control circuit sets the AD conversion completion bit
and the AD interrupt request bit to “1”.
Note that because the comparator consists of a capacitor coupling, set f(XIN) to 500 kHz or more during an A-D conversion.
b7
b0
AD/DA control register
(ADCON : address 003416)
Analog input pin selection bits 1
b2 b1 b0
0
0
0
0
1
1
1
1
[AD/DA Control Register (ADCON)] 003416
The AD/DA control register controls the A-D conversion process.
Bits 0 to 2 and bit 4 select a specific analog input pin. Bit 3 signals
the completion of an A-D conversion. The value of this bit remains
at “0” during an A-D conversion, and changes to “1” when an A-D
conversion ends. Writing “0” to this bit starts the A-D conversion.
0: P60/AN0 or P00/AN8
1: P61/AN1 or P01/AN9
0: P62/AN2 or P02/AN10
1: P63/AN3 or P03/AN11
0: P64/AN4 or P04/AN12
1: P65/AN5 or P05/AN13
0: P66/AN6 or P06/AN14
1: P67/AN7 or P07/AN15
AD conversion completion bit
0: Conversion in progress
1: Conversion completed
Analog input pin selection bit 2
0: AN0 to AN7 side
1: AN8 to AN15 side
Comparison Voltage Generator
The comparison voltage generator divides the voltage between
VREF and AVSS into 1024, and that outputs the comparison voltage
in the 10-bit A-D mode (256 division in 8-bit A-D mode).
The A-D converter successively compares the comparison voltage
Vref in each mode, dividing the VREF voltage (see below), with the
input voltage.
• 10-bit A-D mode (10-bit reading)
Vref = VREF ✕ n (n = 0–1023)
1024
• 10-bit A-D mode (8-bit reading)
Vref = VREF ✕ n (n = 0–255)
256
• 8-bit A-D mode
Vref = VREF ✕ (n–0.5) (n = 1–255)
256
=0
(n = 0)
0
0
1
1
0
0
1
1
Not used (returns “0” when read)
DA1 output enable bit
0: DA1 output disabled
1: DA1 output enabled
DA2 output enable bit
0: DA2 output disabled
1: DA2 output enabled
Fig. 57 Structure of AD/DA control register
10-bit reading
(Read address 003816 before 003516)
b7
A-D conversion register 2
0
(AD2: address 003816)
A-D conversion register 1
(AD1: address 003516)
b0
b9 b8
b7
b0
b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2 b1 b0
Note : Bits 2 to 6 of address 003816 become “0”
at reading.
8-bit reading
(Read only address 003516) b7
b0
A-D conversion register 1
b9 b8 b7 b6 b5 b4 b3 b2
(AD1: address 003516)
Fig. 58 Structure of 10-bit A-D mode reading
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 66 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Data bus
AD/DA control register
(Address 003416)
b7
b0
4
A-D control circuit
Comparator
Channel selector
P60/AN0
P61/AN1
P62/AN2
P63/AN3
P64/AN4
P65/AN5
P66/AN6
P67/AN7
P00/AN8
P01/AN9
P02/AN10
P03/AN11
P04/AN12
P05/AN13
P06/AN14
P07/AN15
Nov 14, 2003
10
Resistor ladder
VREF AVSS
Fig. 59 Block diagram of A-D converter
Rev.4.01
A-D conversion register 2
A-D conversion register 1
page 67 of 136
AD converter interrupt request
(Address 003816)
(Address 003516)
3803/3804 Group
D-A CONVERTER
The 3803/3804 group has two internal D-A converters (DA1 and
DA2) with 8-bit resolution.
The D-A conversion is performed by setting the value in each D-A
conversion register. The result of D-A conversion is output from
the DA1 or DA2 pin by setting the DA output enable bit to “1”.
When using the D-A converter, the corresponding port direction
register bit (P30/DA1 or P31/DA2) must be set to “0” (input status).
The output analog voltage V is determined by the value n (decimal
notation) in the D-A conversion register as follows:
Data bus
D-A1 conversion register (8)
V = VREF ✕ n/256 (n = 0 to 255)
Where VREF is the reference voltage.
R-2R resistor ladder
DA1 output enable bit
P30/DA1
D-A2 conversion register (8)
At reset, the D-A conversion registers are cleared to “0016”, and
the DA output enable bits are cleared to “0”, and the P30/DA1 and
P31/DA2 pins become high impedance.
The DA output does not have buffers. Accordingly, connect an external buffer when driving a low-impedance load.
R-2R resistor ladder
DA2 output enable bit
P31/DA2
Fig. 60 Block diagram of D-A converter
“0” DA1 output enable bit
R
R
R
R
R
R
R
2R
P30/DA1
“1”
2R
2R
MSB
D-A1 conversion register
“0”
“1”
VREF
Fig. 61 Equivalent connection circuit of D-A converter (DA1)
Nov 14, 2003
2R
2R
2R
2R
2R
LSB
AVSS
Rev.4.01
2R
page 68 of 136
3803/3804 Group
WATCHDOG TIMER
The watchdog timer gives a mean of returning to the reset status
when a program cannot run on a normal loop (for example, because of a software run-away). The watchdog timer consists of an
8-bit watchdog timer L and an 8-bit watchdog timer H.
Watchdog Timer Initial Value
Watchdog timer L is set to “FF16” and watchdog timer H is set to
“FF16” by writing to the watchdog timer control register (address
001E16) or at a reset. Any write instruction that causes a write signal can be used, such as the STA, LDM, CLB, etc. Data can only
be written to bits 6 and 7 of the watchdog timer control register.
Regardless of the value written to bits 0 to 5, the above-mentioned
value will be set to each timer.
Watchdog Timer Operations
The watchdog timer stops at reset and a countdown is started by
the writing to the watchdog timer control register. An internal reset
occurs when watchdog timer H underflows. The reset is released
after its release time. After the release, the program is restarted
from the reset vector address. Usually, write to the watchdog timer
control register by software before an underflow of the watchdog
timer H. The watchdog timer does not function if the watchdog
timer control register is not written to at least once.
XCIN
“10”
Main clock division
ratio selection bits
(Note)
XIN
“FF16” is set when
watchdog timer
control register is
written to.
When bit 6 of the watchdog timer control register is kept at “0”, the
STP instruction is enabled. When that is executed, both the clock
and the watchdog timer stop. Count re-starts at the same time as
the release of stop mode (Note). The watchdog timer does not
stop while a WIT instruction is executed. In addition, the STP instruction is disabled by writing “1” to this bit again. When the STP
instruction is executed at this time, it is processed as an undefined
instruction, and an internal reset occurs. Once a “1” is written to
this bit, it cannot be programmed to “0” again.
The following shows the period between the write execution to the
watchdog timer control register and the underflow of watchdog
timer H.
Bit 7 of the watchdog timer control register is “0”:
when XCIN = 32.768 kHz; 32 s
when XIN = 16 MHz; 65.536 ms
Bit 7 of the watchdog timer control register is “1”:
when XCIN = 32.768 kHz; 125 ms
when XIN = 16 MHz; 256 µs
Note: The watchdog timer continues to count even while waiting for a stop
release. Therefore, make sure that watchdog timer H does not underflow during this period.
Data bus
“FF16” is set when
watchdog timer
control register is
written to.
“0”
Watchdog timer L (8)
1/16
“1”
“00”
“01”
Watchdog timer H (8)
Watchdog timer H count
source selection bit
STP instruction disable bit
STP instruction
Reset
circuit
RESET
Internal reset
Reset release time waiting
Note: Either high-speed, middle-speed or low-speed mode is selected by bits 7 and 6 of the CPU mode register.
Fig. 62 Block diagram of Watchdog timer
b0
b7
Watchdog timer control register
(WDTCON : address 001E16)
Watchdog timer H (for read-out of high-order 6 bit)
STP instruction disable bit
0: STP instruction enabled
1: STP instruction disabled
Watchdog timer H count source selection bit
0: Watchdog timer L underflow
1: f(XIN)/16 or f(XCIN)/16
Fig. 63 Structure of Watchdog timer control register
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 69 of 136
3803/3804 Group
MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS INTERFACE
Table 10 Multi-master I2C-BUS interface functions
I2C-BUS
The 3804 group has the multi-master
interface.
The multi-master I2C-BUS interface is a serial communications circuit, conforming to the Philips I2C-BUS data transfer format. This
interface, offering both arbitration lost detection and a synchronous functions, is useful for the multi-master serial
communications.
Figure 64 shows a block diagram of the multi-master I2C-BUS interface and Table 10 lists the multi-master I2 C-BUS interface
functions.
This multi-master I2C-BUS interface consists of the I2C slave address registers 0 to 2, the I2 C data shift register, the I 2C clock
control register, the I2C control register, the I2C status register, the
I2C START/STOP condition control register, the I2C special mode
control register, the I2C special mode status register, and other
control circuits.
When using the multi-master I 2C-BUS interface, set 1 MHz or
more to the internal clock φ.
Interrupt
generating
circuit
Interrupt request signal
(SCL, SDA, IRQ)
Item
Function
In conformity with Philips I2C-BUS
standard:
10-bit addressing format
7-bit addressing format
High-speed clock mode
Standard clock mode
Format
Communication mode
SCL clock frequency
In conformity with Philips I2C-BUS
standard:
Master transmission
Master reception
Slave transmission
Slave reception
16.1 kHz to 400 kHz (at φ= 4 MHz)
System clock φ = f(XIN)/2 (high-speed mode)
φ = f(XIN)/8 (middle-speed mode)
b7 I2C slave address registers 0 to 2 b0
Interrupt
generating
circuit
SAD6 SAD5 SAD4 SAD3 SAD2 SAD1 SAD0 RWB
S0D0–2
Interrupt request signal
(I2CIRQ)
Address comparator
Noise
elimination
circuit
Serial data
(SDA)
Data
control
circuit
b7
b0
I2C data shift register
b7
b0
S0
AL AAS AD0 LRB
MST TRX BB PIN
SIS SIP SSC4 SSC3 SSC2 SSC1 SSC0
AL
circuit
S1
I2C status register
S2D I2C START/STOP condition control
register
Internal data bus
BB
circuit
Serial
clock
(SCL)
Noise
elimination
circuit
Clock
control
circuit
b7
ACK
b0
ACK FAST CCR4 CCR3 CCR2 CCR1 CCR0
BIT MODE
S2
I2C clock control register
Clock division
System clock (φ)
b7
b0
SPCF
PIN2
AAS2 AAS1 AAS0
S3 I2C special mode status register
b7
b7
TISS
b0
TSEL 10 BIT
S AD
SPCFL
b0
PIN2
HD
PIN2
IN
HSLAD ACK I
CON
ALS ES0 BC2 BC1 BC0
S3D I2 C special mode control register
S1D I2C control register
Bit counter
Fig. 64 Block diagram of multi-master I2C-BUS interface
✽ : Purchase of MITSUBISHI ELECTRIC CORPORATIONS I2C components conveys a license under the Philips I2C Patent Rights to use these components
an I2C system, provided that the system conforms to the I2C Standard Specification as defined by Philips.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 70 of 136
3803/3804 Group
[I2C Data Shift Register (S0)] 001116
The I2C data shift register (S0: address 0011 16) is an 8-bit shift
register to store receive data and write transmit data.
When transmit data is written into this register, it is transferred to
the outside from bit 7 in synchronization with the SCL, and each
time one-bit data is output, the data of this register are shifted by
one bit to the left. When data is received, it is input to this register
from bit 0 in synchronization with the SCL, and each time one-bit
data is input, the data of this register are shifted by one bit to the
left. The minimum 2 cycles of the internal clock φ are required
from the rising of the SCL until input to this register.
The I2C data shift register is in a write enable status only when the
I2C-BUS interface enable bit (ES0 bit) of the I2C control register
(S1D: address 001416) is “1”. The bit counter is reset by a write instruction to the I2C data shift register. When both the ES0 bit and
the MST bit of the I2C status register (S1: address 001316) are “1,”
the SCL is output by a write instruction to the I2C data shift register. Reading data from the I2C data shift register is always enabled
regardless of the ES0 bit value.
[I2C Slave Address Registers 0 to 2 (S0D0 to S0D2)]
0FF716 to 0FF916
The I2C slave address registers 0 to 2 (S0D0 to S0D2: addresses
0FF7 16 to 0FF9 16) consists of a 7-bit slave address and a read/
write bit. In the addressing mode, the slave address written in this
register is compared with the address data to be received immediately after the START condition is detected.
•Bit 0: Read/write bit (RWB)
This is not used in the 7-bit addressing mode. In the 10-bit addressing mode, set RWB to “0” because the first address data to
be received is compared with the contents (SAD6 to SAD0 +
RWB) of the I2C slave address registers 0 to 2.
When 2-byte address data match slave address, a 7-bit slave address which is received after restart condition has detected and
R/W data can be matched by setting “1” to RWB with software.
The RWB is cleared to “0” automatically when the stop condition is
detected.
•Bits 1 to 7: Slave address (SAD0–SAD6)
These bits store slave addresses. Regardless of the 7-bit addressing mode or the 10-bit addressing mode, the address data
transmitted from the master is compared with these bits’ contents.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 71 of 136
b7
b0
SAD6 SAD5 SAD4 SAD3 SAD2 SAD1 SAD0 RWB
I2C slave address register 0
(S0D0: address 0FF716)
I2C slave address register 1
(S0D1: address 0FF816)
I2C slave address register 2
(S0D2: address 0FF916)
Read/write bit
Slave address
Fig. 65 Structure of I2C slave address registers 0 to 2
3803/3804 Group
Note: Do not write data into the I2C clock control register during transfer. If
data is written during transfer, the I 2C clock generator is reset, so
that data cannot be transferred normally.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 72 of 136
b0
A CK
B IT
F AST
MODE CCR4 CCR3 CCR2 CCR1 CCR0
I2C clock control register
(S2 : address 001516)
SCL frequency control bits
Refer to Table 11.
SCL mode specification bit
0 : Standard clock mode
1 : High-speed clock mode
ACK bit
0 : ACK is returned.
1 : ACK is not returned.
ACK clock bit
0 : No ACK clock
1 : ACK clock
Fig. 66 Structure of I2C clock control register
Table 11 Set values of I2 C clock control register and SCL
frequency
Setting value of
CCR4–CCR0
CCR4 CCR3 CCR2 CCR1 CCR0
SCL frequency
(at φ = 4 MHz, unit : kHz) (Note 1)
Standard clock High-speed clock
mode
mode
0
0
0
0
0
Setting disabled
Setting disabled
0
0
0
0
1
Setting disabled
Setting disabled
Setting disabled
333
0
0
1
0
0
0
0
1
1
– (Note 2)
0
0
1
0
0
– (Note 2)
250
0
0
1
0
1
100
400 (Note 3)
0
0
1
1
0
83.3
166
…
0
Setting disabled
…
•Bit 7: ACK clock bit (ACK)
This bit specifies the mode of acknowledgment which is an acknowledgment response of data transfer. When this bit is set to
“0,” the no ACK clock mode is selected. In this case, no ACK clock
occurs after data transmission. When the bit is set to “1,” the ACK
clock mode is selected and the master generates an ACK clock
each completion of each 1-byte data transfer. The device for
transmitting address data and control data releases the SDA at
the occurrence of an ACK clock (makes SDA “H”) and receives the
ACK bit generated by the data receiving device.
ACK
…
✽ACK clock: Clock for acknowledgment
b7
…
The I2C clock control register (S2: address 001516) is used to set
ACK control, SCL mode and SCL frequency.
•Bits 0 to 4: SCL frequency control bits (CCR0–CCR4)
These bits control the SCL frequency. Refer to Table 11.
•Bit 5: SCL mode specification bit (FAST MODE)
This bit specifies the SCL mode. When this bit is set to “0,” the
standard clock mode is selected. When the bit is set to “1,” the
high-speed clock mode is selected.
When connecting the bus of the high-speed mode I 2C bus standard (maximum 400 kbits/s), use 8 MHz or more oscillation
frequency f(XIN) in the high-speed mode (2 division clock).
•Bit 6: ACK bit (ACK BIT)
This bit sets the SDA status when an ACK clock ✽ is generated.
When this bit is set to “0,” the ACK return mode is selected and
SDA goes to “L” at the occurrence of an ACK clock. When the bit
is set to “1,” the ACK non-return mode is selected. The SDA is
held in the “H” status at the occurrence of an ACK clock.
However, when the slave address agree with the address data in
the reception of address data at ACK BIT = “0,” the SDA is automatically made “L” (ACK is returned). If there is a disagreement
between the slave address and the address data, the SDA is automatically made “H” (ACK is not returned).
…
[I2C Clock Control Register (S2)] 001516
500/CCR value
(Note 3)
1
1
1
0
1
17.2
1000/CCR value
(Note 3)
34.5
1
1
1
1
0
16.6
33.3
1
1
1
1
1
16.1
32.3
Notes 1: Duty of SCL output is 50 %. The duty becomes 35 to 45 % only
when the high-speed clock mode is selected and CCR value = 5
(400 kHz, at φ = 4 MHz). “H” duration of the clock fluctuates from
–4 to +2 machine cycles in the standard clock mode, and fluctuates from –2 to +2 machine cycles in the high-speed clock mode.
In the case of negative fluctuation, the frequency does not increase because “L” duration is extended instead of “H” duration
reduction.
These are values when SCL synchronization by the synchronous
function is not performed. CCR value is the decimal notation
value of the SCL frequency control bits CCR4 to CCR0.
2: Each value of SCL frequency exceeds the limit at φ = 4 MHz or
more. When using these setting value, use φ of 4 MHz or less.
3: The data formula of SCL frequency is described below:
φ/(8 ✕ CCR value) Standard clock mode
φ/(4 ✕ CCR value) High-speed clock mode (CCR value ≠ 5)
φ/(2 ✕ CCR value) High-speed clock mode (CCR value = 5)
Do not set 0 to 2 as CCR value regardless of φ frequency.
Set 100 kHz (max.) in the standard clock mode and 400 kHz
(max.) in the high-speed clock mode to the SCL frequency by
setting the SCL frequency control bits CCR4 to CCR0.
3803/3804 Group
[I2C Control Register (S1D)] 001416
The I2C control register (S1D: address 001416) controls data communication format.
•Bits 0 to 2: Bit counter (BC0–BC2)
These bits decide the number of bits for the next 1-byte data to be
transmitted. The I2C interrupt request signal occurs immediately
after the number of count specified with these bits (ACK clock is
added to the number of count when ACK clock is selected by ACK
clock bit (bit 7 of S2, address 001516) have been transferred, and
BC0 to BC2 are returned to “0002”.
Also when a START condition is received, these bits become
“0002” and the address data is always transmitted and received in
8 bits.
•Bit 3: I2C interface enable bit (ES0)
This bit enables to use the multi-master I2C-BUS interface. When
this bit is set to “0,” the use disable status is provided, so that the
SDA and the SCL become high-impedance. When the bit is set to
“1,” use of the interface is enabled.
When ES0 = “0,” the following is performed.
• PIN = “1,” BB = “0” and AL = “0” are set (which are bits of the I2C
status register, S1, at address 001316 ).
• Writing data to the I2C data shift register (S0: address 001116) is
disabled.
•Bit 4: Data format selection bit (ALS)
This bit decides whether or not to recognize slave addresses.
When this bit is set to “0,” the addressing format is selected, so
that address data is recognized. When a match is found between
a slave address and address data as a result of comparison or
when a general call (refer to “I 2C Status Register,” bit 1) is received, transfer processing can be performed. When this bit is set
to “1,” the free data format is selected, so that slave addresses are
not recognized.
•Bit 5: Addressing format selection bit (10BIT SAD)
This bit selects a slave address specification format. When this bit
is set to “0,” the 7-bit addressing format is selected. In this case,
only the high-order 7 bits (slave address) of the I2C slave address
registers 0 to 2 are compared with address data. When this bit is
set to “1,” the 10-bit addressing format is selected, and all the bits
of the I2C slave address registers 0 to 2 are compared with address data.
•Bit 7: I2C-BUS interface pin input level selection bit (TISS)
This bit selects the input level of the SCL and SDA pins of the
multi-master I2C-BUS interface.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 73 of 136
b7
TISS
b0
10 BIT
SAD
ALS ES0 BC2 BC1 BC0
I2C control register
(S1D : address 001416)
Bit counter (Number of
transmit/receive bits)
b2 b1 b0
0 0 0 : 8
0 0 1 : 7
0 1 0 : 6
0 1 1 : 5
1 0 0 : 4
1 0 1 : 3
1 1 0 : 2
1 1 1 : 1
I2C-BUS interface
enable bit
0 : Disabled
1 : Enabled
Data format selection bit
0 : Addressing format
1 : Free data format
Addressing format
selection bit
0 : 7-bit addressing
format
1 : 10-bit
addressing format
Not used
(return “0” when read)
I2C-BUS interface pin input
level selection bit
0 : SMBUS input
1 : CMOS input
Fig. 67 Structure of I2C control register
3803/3804 Group
[I2C Status Register (S1)] 001316
The I2C status register (S1: address 001316) controls the I2C-BUS
interface status. The low-order 4 bits are read-only bits and the
high-order 4 bits can be read out and written to.
Set “00002” to the low-order 4 bits, because these bits become the
reserved bits at writing.
•Bit 0: Last receive bit (LRB)
This bit stores the last bit value of received data and can also be
used for ACK receive confirmation. If ACK is returned when an
ACK clock occurs, the LRB bit is set to “0.” If ACK is not returned,
this bit is set to “1.” Except in the ACK mode, the last bit value of
received data is input. The state of this bit is changed from “1” to
“0” by executing a write instruction to the I 2C data shift register
(S0: address 001116).
•Bit 1: General call detecting flag (AD0)
When the ALS bit is “0”, this bit is set to “1” when a general call✽
whose address data is all “0” is received in the slave mode. By a
general call of the master device, every slave device receives control data after the general call. The AD0 bit is set to “0” by
detecting the STOP condition or START condition, or reset.
✽General call: The master transmits the general call address “0016” to all
slaves.
•Bit 2: Slave address comparison flag (AAS)
This flag indicates a comparison result of address data when the
ALS bit is “0”.
➀ In the slave receive mode, when the 7-bit addressing format is
selected, this bit is set to “1” in one of the following conditions:
• The address data immediately after occurrence of a START
condition agrees with the slave address stored in the high-order 7 bits of the I2C slave address register.
• A general call is received.
➁ In the slave receive mode, when the 10-bit addressing format is
selected, this bit is set to “1” with the following condition:
• When the address data is compared with the I 2 C slave address register (8 bits consisting of slave address and RWB
bit), the first bytes agree.
➂ This bit is set to “0” by executing a write instruction to the I2C
data shift register (S0: address 001116) when ES0 is set to “1”
or reset.
•Bit 3: Arbitration lost✽ detecting flag (AL)
In the master transmission mode, when the SDA is made “L” by
any other device, arbitration is judged to have been lost, so that
this bit is set to “1.” At the same time, the TRX bit is set to “0,” so
that immediately after transmission of the byte whose arbitration
was lost is completed, the MST bit is set to “0.” The arbitration lost
can be detected only in the master transmission mode. When arbitration is lost during slave address transmission, the TRX bit is
set to “0” and the reception mode is set. Consequently, it becomes
possible to detect the agreement of its own slave address and address data transmitted by another master device.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 74 of 136
The AL bit is set to “0” in one of the following conditions:
•Executing a write instruction to the I2C data shift register (S0: address 001116)
•When the ES0 bit is “0”
•At reset
✽Arbitration lost :The status in which communication as a master is disabled.
•Bit 4: SCL pin low hold bit (PIN)
This bit generates an interrupt request signal. Each time 1-byte
data is transmitted, the PIN bit changes from “1” to “0.” At the
same time, an interrupt request signal occurs to the CPU. The PIN
bit is set to “0” in synchronization with a falling of the last clock (including the ACK clock) of an internal clock and an interrupt
request signal occurs in synchronization with a falling of the PIN
bit. When the PIN bit is “0,” the SCL is kept in the “0” state and
clock generation is disabled. Figure 69 shows an interrupt request
signal generating timing chart.
The PIN bit is set to “1” in one of the following conditions:
• Executing a write instruction to the I2C data shift register (S0:
address 001116). (This is the only condition which the prohibition
of the internal clock is released and data can be communicated
except for the start condition detection.)
• When the ES0 bit is “0”
• At reset
• When writing “1” to the PIN bit by software
The PIN bit is set to “0” in one of the following conditions:
• Immediately after completion of 1-byte data transmission (including when arbitration lost is detected)
• Immediately after completion of 1-byte data reception
• In the slave reception mode, with ALS = “0” and immediately after completion of slave address agreement or general call
address reception
• In the slave reception mode, with ALS = “1” and immediately after completion of address data reception
•Bit 5: Bus busy flag (BB)
This bit indicates the status of use of the bus system. When this
bit is set to “0,” this bus system is not busy and a START condition
can be generated. The BB flag is set/reset by the SCL, SDA pins
input signal regardless of master/slave. This flag is set to “1” by
detecting the START condition, and is set to “0” by detecting the
STOP condition. The condition of these detecting is set by the
START/STOP condition setting bits (SSC4–SSC0) of the I 2C
START/STOP condition control register (S2D: address 001616).
When the ES0 bit of the I2C control register (bit 3 of S1D, address
001416) is “0” or reset, the BB flag is set to “0.”
For the writing function to the BB flag, refer to the sections
“START Condition Generating Method” and “STOP Condition Generating Method” described later.
3803/3804 Group
•Bit 6: Communication mode specification bit (transfer direction specification bit: TRX)
This bit decides a direction of transfer for data communication.
When this bit is “0,” the reception mode is selected and the data of
a transmitting device is received. When the bit is “1,” the transmission mode is selected and address data and control data are
output onto the SDA in synchronization with the clock generated
on the SCL.
This bit is set/reset by software and hardware. About set/reset by
hardware is described below. This bit is set to “1” by hardware
when all the following conditions are satisfied:
• When ALS is “0”
• In the slave reception mode or the slave transmission mode
• When the R/W bit reception is “1”
This bit is set to “0” in one of the following conditions:
• When arbitration lost is detected.
• When a STOP condition is detected.
• When writing “1” to this bit by software is invalid by the START
condition duplication preventing function (Note).
• With MST = “0” and when a START condition is detected.
• With MST = “0” and when ACK non-return is detected.
• At reset
•Bit 7: Communication mode specification bit (master/slave
specification bit: MST)
This bit is used for master/slave specification for data communication. When this bit is “0,” the slave is specified, so that a START
condition and a STOP condition generated by the master are received, and data communication is performed in synchronization
with the clock generated by the master. When this bit is “1,” the
master is specified and a START condition and a STOP condition
are generated. Additionally, the clocks required for data communication are generated on the SCL.
This bit is set to “0” in one of the following conditions.
• Immediately after completion of the byte which has lost arbitration when arbitration lost is detected
• When a STOP condition is detected.
• Writing “1” to this bit by software is invalid by the START condition duplication preventing function (Note).
• At reset
Note: START condition duplication preventing function
The MST, TRX, and BB bits is set to “1” at the same time after confirming that the BB flag is “0” in the procedure of a START condition
occurrence. However, when a START condition by another master
device occurs and the BB flag is set to “1” immediately after the contents of the BB flag is confirmed, the START condition duplication
preventing function makes the writing to the MST and TRX bits invalid. The duplication preventing function becomes valid from the
rising of the BB flag to reception completion of slave address.
b7
b0
MST TRX BB PIN AL AAS AD0 LRB
I2C status register
(S1 : address 001316)
Last receive bit (Note)
0 : Last bit = “0”
1 : Last bit = “1”
General call detecting flag
(Note)
0 : No general call detected
1 : General call detected
Slave address comparison flag
(Note)
0 : Address disagreement
1 : Address agreement
Arbitration lost detecting flag
(Note)
0 : Not detected
1 : Detected
SCL pin low hold bit
0 : SCL pin low hold
1 : SCL pin low release
Bus busy flag
0 : Bus free
1 : Bus busy
Communication mode
specification bits
00 : Slave receive mode
01 : Slave transmit mode
10 : Master receive mode
11 : Master transmit mode
Note: These bits and flags can be read out, but cannot be written.
Write “0” to these bits at writing.
Fig. 68 Structure of I2C status register
SCL
PIN
I2CIRQ
Fig. 69 Interrupt request signal generating timing
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 75 of 136
3803/3804 Group
START Condition Generating Method
STOP Condition Generating Method
When writing “1” to the MST, TRX, and BB bits of the I2C status
register (S1: address 001316) at the same time after writing the
slave address to the I2C data shift register (S0: address 001116)
with the condition in which the ES0 bit of the I2C control register
(S1D: address 001416) is “1” and the BB flag is “0”, a START condition occurs. After that, the bit counter becomes “0002” and an
SCL for 1 byte is output. The START condition generating timing is
different in the standard clock mode and the high-speed clock
mode. Refer to Figure 70, the START condition generating timing
diagram, and Table 12, the START condition generating timing
table.
When the ES0 bit of the I 2 C control register (S1D: address
001416) is “1,” write “1” to the MST and TRX bits, and write “0” to
the BB bit of the I2C status register (S1: address 001316) simultaneously. Then a STOP condition occurs. The STOP condition
generating timing is different in the standard clock mode and the
high-speed clock mode. Refer to Figure 71, the STOP condition
generating timing diagram, and Table 13, the STOP condition generating timing table.
I2C status register
write signal
SCL
I2C status register
write signal
SCL
SDA
SDA
Setup
time
Hold time
Fig. 70 START condition generating timing diagram
Setup time
5.0 µs (20 cycles)
2.5 µs (10 cycles)
Hold time
5.0 µs (20 cycles)
2.5 µs (10 cycles)
Note: Absolute time at φ = 4 MHz. The value in parentheses denotes the
number of φ cycles.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 76 of 136
Hold time
Fig. 71 STOP condition generating timing diagram
Table 13 STOP condition generating timing table
Standard clock mode
High-speed clock mode
Item
5.0 µs (20 cycles)
3.0 µs (12 cycles)
Setup time
Hold time
Table 12 START condition generating timing table
Standard clock mode High-speed clock mode
Item
Setup
time
4.5 µs (18 cycles)
2.5 µs (10 cycles)
Note: Absolute time at φ = 4 MHz. The value in parentheses denotes the
number of φ cycles.
3803/3804 Group
START/STOP Condition Detecting Operation
The START/STOP condition detection operations are shown in
Figures 72, 73, and Table 14. The START/STOP condition is set
by the START/STOP condition set bit.
The START/STOP condition can be detected only when the input
signal of the SCL and SDA pins satisfy three conditions: SCL release time, setup time, and hold time (see Table 14).
The BB flag is set to “1” by detecting the START condition and is
reset to “0” by detecting the STOP condition.
The BB flag set/reset timing is different in the standard clock mode
and the high-speed clock mode. Refer to Table 14, the BB flag set/
reset time.
Note: When a STOP condition is detected in the slave mode (MST = 0), an
interrupt request signal “I2CIRQ” occurs to the CPU.
SCL release time
SCL
SDA
SCL release time
Setup time
Hold time
BB flag set/
reset time
SSC value + 1 cycle (6.25 µs)
4 cycles (1.0 µs)
SSC value + 1 cycle < 4.0 µs (3.125 µs)
2 cycles (0.5 µs)
2
SSC value + 1 cycle < 4.0 µs (3.125 µs) 2 cycles (0.5 µs)
2
SSC value –1
+ 2 cycles (3.375 µs) 3.5 cycles (0.875 µs)
2
Note: Unit : Cycle number of internal clock φ
SSC value is the decimal notation value of the START/STOP condition set bits SSC4 to SSC0. Do not set “0” or an odd number to SSC
value. The value in parentheses is an example when the I2C START/
STOP condition control register is set to “1816” at φ = 4 MHz.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 77 of 136
Hold time
BB flag
set time
BB flag
Fig. 72 START/STOP condition detecting timing diagram
SCL release time
SCL
SDA
BB flag
Table 14 START condition/STOP condition detecting conditions
Standard clock mode
High-speed clock mode
Setup
time
Setup
time
Hold time
BB flag
reset
time
Fig. 73 STOP condition detecting timing diagram
3803/3804 Group
[I2C START/STOP Condition Control Register
(S2D)] 001616
The I2C START/STOP condition control register (S2D: address
001616) controls START/STOP condition detection.
•Bits 0 to 4: START/STOP condition set bits (SSC4–SSC0)
SCL release time, setup time, and hold time change the detection
condition by value of the main clock divide ratio selection bit and
the oscillation frequency f(XIN) because these time are measured
by the internal system clock. Accordingly, set the proper value to
the START/STOP condition set bits (SSC4 to SSC0) in considered
of the system clock frequency. Refer to Table 14.
Do not set “000002” or an odd number to the START/STOP condition set bits (SSC4 to SSC0).
Refer to Table 15, the recommended set value to START/STOP
condition set bits (SSC4–SSC0) for each oscillation frequency.
•Bit 5: SCL/SDA interrupt pin polarity selection bit (SIP)
An interrupt can occur when detecting the falling or rising edge of
the SCL or SDA pin. This bit selects the polarity of the SCL or SDA
pin interrupt pin.
b7
•Bit 6: SCL/SDA interrupt pin selection bit (SIS)
This bit selects the pin of which interrupt becomes valid between
the SCL pin and the SDA pin.
Note: When changing the setting of the SCL/SDA interrupt pin polarity selection bit, the SCL/SDA interrupt pin selection bit, or the I2C-BUS
interface enable bit ES0, the SCL/SDA interrupt request bit may be
set. When selecting the SCL/SDA interrupt source, disable the interrupt before the SCL/SDA interrupt pin polarity selection bit, the SCL/
SDA interrupt pin selection bit, or the I2C-BUS interface enable bit
ES0 is set. Reset the request bit to “0” after setting these bits, and
enable the interrupt.
b0
SIS SIP SSC4 SSC3 SSC2 SSC1 SSC0
I2C START/STOP condition
control register
(S2D : address 001616)
START/STOP condition set bits
SCL/SDA interrupt pin polarity
selection bit
0 : Falling edge active
1 : Rising edge active
SCL/SDA interrupt pin selection bit
0 : SDA valid
1 : SCL valid
Not used
(Fix this bit to “0”.)
Fig. 74 Structure of I2C START/STOP condition control register
Table 15 Recommended set value to START/STOP condition set bits (SSC4–SSC0) for each oscillation frequency
Oscillation
frequency
f(XIN) (MHz)
Main clock
divide ratio
Internal
clock φ
(MHz)
8
2
4
8
8
1
4
2
2
2
2
1
START/STOP
condition
control register
SCL release time
(µs)
XXX11010
XXX11000
Setup time
(µs)
Hold time
(µs)
6.75 µs (27 cycles)
3.5 µs (14 cycles)
3.25 µs (13 cycles)
6.25 µs (25 cycles)
3.25 µs (13 cycles)
3.0 µs (12 cycles)
XXX00100
5.0 µs (5 cycles)
3.0 µs (3 cycles)
2.0 µs (2 cycles)
XXX01100
6.5 µs (13 cycles)
3.5 µs (7 cycles)
3.0 µs (6 cycles)
XXX01010
5.5 µs (11 cycles)
3.0 µs (6 cycles)
2.5 µs (5 cycles)
XXX00100
5.0 µs (5 cycles)
3.0 µs (3 cycles)
2.0 µs (2 cycles)
Note: Do not set an odd number to the START/STOP condition set bits (SSC4 to SSC0) and “000002”.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 78 of 136
3803/3804 Group
[I 2 C Special Mode Status Register (S3)]
001216
The I2C special mode status register (S3: address 001216) consists of the flags indicating I2C operating state in the I2C special
mode, which is set by the I2C special mode control register (S3D:
address 001716).
The stop condition flag is valid in all operating modes.
•Bit 0: Slave address 0 comparison flag (AAS0)
Bit 1: Slave address 1 comparison flag (AAS1)
Bit 2: Slave address 2 comparison flag (AAS2)
These flags indicate a comparison result of address data. These
flags are valid only when the slave address control bit (MSLAD) is
“1”.
In the 7-bit addressing format of the slave reception mode, the respective slave address i (i = 0, 1, 2) comparison flags
corresponding to the I2C slave address registers 0 to 2 are set to
“1” when an address data immediately after an occurrence of a
START condition agrees with the high-order 7-bit slave address
stored in the I2C slave address registers 0 to 2 (addresses 0FF716
to 0FF916).
In the 10-bit addressing format of the slave mode, the respective
slave address i (i = 0, 1, 2) comparison flags corresponding to the
I2C slave address registers are set to “1” when an address data is
compared with the 8 bits consisting of the slave address stored in
the I2C slave address registers 0 to 2 and the RWB bit, and the
first byte agrees.
These flags are initialized to “0” at reset, when the slave address
control bit (MSLAD) is “0”, or when writing data to the I 2C data
shift register (S0: address 001116).
b7
SP CF
•Bit 5: SCL pin low hold 2 flag (PIN2)
When the ACK interrupt control bit (ACKICON) and the ACK clock
bit (ACK) are “1”, this flag is set to “0” in synchronization with the
falling of the data’s last SCL clock, just before the ACK clock. The
SCL pin is simultaneously held low, and the I2C interrupt request
occurs.
This flag is initialized to “1” at reset, when the ACK interrupt control bit (ACKICON) is “0”, or when writing “1” to the SCL pin low
hold 2 flag set bit (PIN2IN).
The SCL pin is held low when either the SCL pin low hold bit (PIN)
or the SCL pin low hold 2 flag (PIN2) becomes “0”. The low hold
state of the SCL pin is released when both the SCL pin low hold
bit (PIN) and the SCL pin low hold 2 flag (PIN2) are “1”.
•Bit 7: Stop condition flag (SPCF)
This flag is set to “1” when a STOP condition occurs.
This flag is initialized to “0” at reset, when the I 2C-BUS interface
enable bit (ES0) is “0”, or when writing “1” to the STOP condition
flag clear bit (SPFCL).
b0
PIN2
AA S2 AA S1 AA S0
I2C special mode status register
(S3 : address 001216)
Slave address 0 comparison flag
0 : Address disagreement
1 : Address agreement
Slave address 1 comparison flag
0 : Address disagreement
1 : Address agreement
Slave address 2 comparison flag
0 : Address disagreement
1 : Address agreement
Not used
(return “0” when read)
Not used
(return “0” when read)
SCL pin low hold 2 flag
0 : SCL pin low hold
1 : SCL pin low release (Note)
Not used
(return “0” when read)
STOP condition flag
0 : No detection
1 : Detection
Note: In order that the low hold state of the SCL pin may release, it is
necessary that the SCL pin low hold 2 flag and the SCL pin low
hold bit (PIN) are “1” simultaneously.
Fig. 75 Structure of I2C special mode status register
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 79 of 136
3803/3804 Group
[I 2C Special Mode Control Register (S3D)]
001716
The I2C special mode control register (S3D: address 001716) controls special functions such as occurrence timing of reception
interrupt request and extending slave address comparison to 3
bytes.
•Bit 1: ACK interrupt control bit (ACKICON)
This bit controls the timing of I2C interrupt request occurrence at
completion of data receiving due to master reception or slave reception.
When this bit is “0”, the SCL pin low hold bit (PIN) is set to “0” in
synchronization with the falling of the last SCL clock, including the
ACK clock. The SCL pin is simultaneously held low, and the I2C
interrupt request occurs.
When this bit is “1” and the ACK clock bit (ACK) is “1”, the SCL pin
low hold 2 flag (PIN2) is set to “0” in synchronization with the falling of the data’s last SCL clock, just before the ACK clock. The
SCL pin is simultaneously held low, and the I2C interrupt request
occurs again. The ACK bit can be changed after the contents of
data are confirmed by using this function.
b7
SPFCL
•Bit 2: I2C slave address control bit (MSLAD)
This bit controls a slave address. When this bit is “0”, only the I2C
slave address register 0 (address 0FF7 16 ) becomes valid as a
slave address and a read/write bit.
When this bit is “1”, all of the I2C slave address registers 0 to 2
(addresses 0FF716 to 0FF916) become valid as a slave address
and a read/write bit. In this case, when an address data agrees
with any one of the I2C slave address registers 0 to 2, the slave
address comparison flag (AAS) is set to “1” and the I2C slave address comparison flag corresponding to the agreed I 2 C slave
address registers 0 to 2 is also set to “1”.
•Bit 5: SCL pin low hold 2 flag set bit (PIN2IN)
Writing “1” to this bit initializes the SCL pin low hold 2 flag (PIN2)
to “1”.
When writing “0”, nothing is generated.
•Bit 6: SCL pin low hold set bit (PIN2HD)
When the SCL pin low hold bit (PIN) becomes “0”, the SCL pin is
held low. However, the SCL pin low hold bit (PIN) cannot be set to
“0” by software. The SCL pin low hold set bit (PIN2HD) is used to ,
hold the SCL pin in the low state by software. When writing “1” to
this bit, the SCL pin low hold 2 flag (PIN2) becomes “0”, and the
SCL pin is held low. When writing “0”, nothing occurs.
•Bit 7: STOP condition flag clear bit (SPFCL)
Writing “1” to this bit initializes the STOP condition flag (SPCF) to
“0”.
When writing “0”, nothing is generated.
b0
PIN2PIN2IN
HD
MSLAD
ACKI
CON
I2C special mode control register
(S3D : address 001716)
Not used
(Fix this bit to “0”.)
ACK interrupt control bit
0 : At communication completion
1 : At falling of ACK clock and communication
completion
Slave address control bit
0 : One-byte slave address compare mode
1 : Three-byte slave address compare mode
Not used
(return “0” when read)
Not used
(Fix this bit to “0”.)
SCL pin low hold 2 flag set bit (Notes 1, 2)
Writing “1” to this bit initializes the SCL pin low
hold 2 flag to “1”.
SCL pin low hold set bit (Notes 1, 2)
When writing “1” to this bit, the SCL pin low
hold 2 flag becomes “0” and the SCL pin is held
low.
STOP condition flag clear bit (Note 2)
Writing “1” to this bit initializes the STOP
condition flag to “0”.
Notes 1: Do not write “1” to these bits simultaneously.
2: return “0” when read
Fig. 76 Structure of I2C special mode control register
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 80 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Address Data Communication
parison, an address comparison between the RWB bit of the
I2C slave address register and the R/W bit which is the last bit
of the address data transmitted from the master is made. In the
10-bit addressing mode, the RWB bit which is the last bit of the
address data not only specifies the direction of communication
for control data, but also is processed as an address data bit.
When the first-byte address data agree with the slave address,
the AAS bit of the I2C status register (S1: address 001316) is
set to “1.” After the second-byte address data is stored into the
I2C data shift register (S0: address 0011 16 ), perform an address comparison between the second-byte data and the slave
address by software. When the address data of the 2 bytes
agree with the slave address, set the RWB bit of the I2C slave
address register to “1” by software. This processing can make
the 7-bit slave address and R/W data agree, which are received after a RESTART condition is detected, with the value of
the I2C slave address register. For the data transmission format when the 10-bit addressing format is selected, refer to
Figure 77, (3) and (4).
There are two address data communication formats, namely, 7-bit
addressing format and 10-bit addressing format. The respective
address communication formats are described below.
➀ 7-bit addressing format
To adapt the 7-bit addressing format, set the 10BIT SAD bit of
the I2C control register (S1D: address 001416) to “0”. The first 7bit address data transmitted from the master is compared with
the high-order 7-bit slave address stored in the I2 C slave address register. At the time of this comparison, address
comparison of the RWB bit of the I2C slave address register is
not performed. For the data transmission format when the 7-bit
addressing format is selected, refer to Figure 77, (1) and (2).
➁ 10-bit addressing format
To adapt the 10-bit addressing format, set the 10BIT SAD bit of
the I 2C control register (S1D: address 0014 16) to “1.” An address comparison is performed between the first-byte address
data transmitted from the master and the 8-bit slave address
stored in the I2C slave address register. At the time of this com-
(1) A master-transmitter transmits data to a slave-receiver
S
Slave address R/W
7 bits
A
“0”
Data
A
1 to 8 bits
Data
A/A
P
A
P
1 to 8 bits
(2) A master-receiver receives data from a slave-transmitter
S
Slave address R/W
7 bits
A
“1”
Data
A
1 to 8 bits
Data
1 to 8 bits
(3) A master-transmitter transmits data to a slave-receiver with a 10-bit address
S
Slave address
R/W
1st 7 bits
7 bits
A
“0”
Slave address
2nd bytes
A
Data
1 to 8 bits
8 bits
Data
A
A/A
P
1 to 8 bits
(4) A master-receiver receives data from a slave-transmitter with a 10-bit address
S
Slave address
R/W
1st 7 bits
7 bits
S : START condition
A : ACK bit
Sr : Restart condition
“0”
A
Slave address
2nd bytes
8 bits
P : STOP condition
R/W : Read/Write bit
Nov 14, 2003
Sr
Slave address
R/W
1st 7 bits
7 bits
: Master to slave
: Slave to master
Fig. 77 Address data communication format
Rev.4.01
A
page 81 of 136
“1”
A
Data
1 to 8 bits
A
Data
1 to 8 bits
A
P
3803/3804 Group
Example of Master Transmission
Example of Slave Reception
An example of master transmission in the standard clock mode, at
the SCL frequency of 100 kHz and in the ACK return mode is
shown below.
➀ Set a slave address in the high-order 7 bits of the I2C slave address register and “0” into the RWB bit.
➁ Set the ACK return mode and SCL = 100 kHz by setting “8516”
in the I2C clock control register (S2: address 001516).
➂ Set “0016” in the I2C status register (S1: address 0013 16) so
that transmission/reception mode can become initializing condition.
➃ Set a communication enable status by setting “0816” in the I2C
control register (S1D: address 001416).
➄ Confirm the bus free condition by the BB flag of the I2C status
register (S1: address 001316).
➅ Set the address data of the destination of transmission in the
high-order 7 bits of the I 2C data shift register (S0: address
001116) and set “0” in the least significant bit.
➆ Set “F0 16” in the I2C status register (S1: address 0013 16) to
generate a START condition. At this time, an SCL for 1 byte and
an ACK clock automatically occur.
➇ Set transmit data in the I 2C data shift register (S0: address
001116). At this time, an SCL and an ACK clock automatically
occur.
➈ When transmitting control data of more than 1 byte, repeat step
➇.
➉ Set “D0 16” in the I2C status register (S1: address 001316 ) to
generate a STOP condition if ACK is not returned from slave reception side or transmission ends.
An example of slave reception in the high-speed clock mode, at
the SCL frequency of 400 kHz, in the ACK non-return mode and
using the addressing format is shown below.
➀ Set a slave address in the high-order 7 bits of the I2C slave address register and “0” in the RWB bit.
➁ Set the no ACK clock mode and SCL = 400 kHz by setting
“2516” in the I2C clock control register (S2: address 001516).
➂ Set “0016 ” in the I2C status register (S1: address 0013 16) so
that transmission/reception mode can become initializing condition.
➃ Set a communication enable status by setting “0816” in the I2C
control register (S1D: address 001416).
➄ When a START condition is received, an address comparison is
performed.
➅ •When all transmitted addresses are “0” (general call):
AD0 of the I2C status register (S1: address 001316) is set to “1”
and an interrupt request signal occurs.
• When the transmitted addresses agree with the address set in
➀:
AAS of the I2C status register (S1: address 001316) is set to
“1” and an interrupt request signal occurs.
• In the cases other than the above AD0 and AAS of the I2C status register (S1: address 001316) are set to “0” and no interrupt
request signal occurs.
➆ Set dummy data in the I 2 C data shift register (S0: address
001116).
➇ When receiving control data of more than 1 byte, repeat step ➆.
➈ When a STOP condition is detected, the communication ends.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 82 of 136
3803/3804 Group
■Precautions when using multi-master I2CBUS interface
(1) Read-modify-write instruction
The precautions when the read-modify-write instruction such as
SEB, CLB etc. is executed for each register of the multi-master
I2C-BUS interface are described below.
• I2C data shift register (S0: address 001116)
When executing the read-modify-write instruction for this register during transfer, data may become a value not intended.
• I2C slave address registers 0 to 2 (S0D0 to S0D2: addresses
0FF716 to0FF916)
When the read-modify-write instruction is executed for this register at detecting the STOP condition, data may become a value
not intended. It is because H/W changes the read/write bit
(RWB) at the above timing.
• I2C status register (S1: address 001316)
Do not execute the read-modify-write instruction for this register
because all bits of this register are changed by H/W.
• I2C control register (S1D: address 001416)
When the read-modify-write instruction is executed for this register at detecting the START condition or at completing the byte
transfer, data may become a value not intended. Because H/W
changes the bit counter (BC0-BC2) at the above timing.
• I2C clock control register (S2: address 001516)
The read-modify-write instruction can be executed for this register.
• I 2 C START/STOP condition control register (S2D: address
001616)
The read-modify-write instruction can be executed for this register.
(2) START condition generating procedure using multi-master
1. Procedure example (The necessary conditions of the generating procedure are described as the following 2 to 5.
::
LDA —
(Taking out of slave address value)
SEI
(Interrupt disabled)
BBS 5, S1, BUSBUSY (BB flag confirming and branch process)
BUSFREE:
STA S0
(Writing of slave address value)
LDM #$F0, S1
(Trigger of START condition generating)
CLI
(Interrupt enabled)
::
BUSBUSY:
CLI
(Interrupt enabled)
::
2. Use “Branch on Bit Set” of “BBS 5, S1, –” for the BB flag confirming and branch process.
3. Use “STA $12, STX $12” or “STY $12” of the zero page addressing instruction for writing the slave address value to the
I2C data shift register.
4. Execute the branch instruction of above 2 and the store instruction of above 3 continuously shown the above procedure
example.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 83 of 136
5. Disable interrupts during the following three process steps:
• BB flag confirming
• Writing of slave address value
• Trigger of START condition generating
When the condition of the BB flag is bus busy, enable interrupts
immediately.
(3) RESTART condition generating procedure
1. Procedure example (The necessary conditions of the generating procedure are described as the following 2 to 4.)
Execute the following procedure when the PIN bit is “0.”
::
LDM #$00, S1
(Select slave receive mode)
LDA —
(Taking out of slave address value)
SEI
(Interrupt disabled)
STA S0
(Writing of slave address value)
LDM #$F0, S1
(Trigger of RESTART condition generating)
CLI
(Interrupt enabled)
::
2. Select the slave receive mode when the PIN bit is “0.” Do not
write “1” to the PIN bit. Neither “0” nor “1” is specified for the
writing to the BB bit.
The TRX bit becomes “0” and the SDA pin is released.
3. The SCL pin is released by writing the slave address value to
the I2C data shift register.
4. Disable interrupts during the following two process steps:
• Writing of slave address value
• Trigger of RESTART condition generating
(4) Writing to I2C status register
Do not execute an instruction to set the PIN bit to “1” from “0” and
an instruction to set the MST and TRX bits to “0” from “1” simultaneously. It is because it may enter the state that the SCL pin is
released and the SDA pin is released after about one machine
cycle. Do not execute an instruction to set the MST and TRX bits
to “0” from “1” simultaneously when the PIN bit is “1.” It is because
it may become the same as above.
(5) Process of after STOP condition generating
Do not write data in the I2C data shift register S0 and the I2C status register S1 until the bus busy flag BB becomes “0” after
generating the STOP condition in the master mode. It is because
the STOP condition waveform might not be normally generated.
Reading to the above registers does not have the problem.
3803/3804 Group
RESET CIRCUIT
To reset the microcomputer, RESET pin should be held at an "L"
level for 16 cycles or more of XIN. Then the RESET pin is returned
to an "H" level (the power source voltage should be between 2.7 V
and 5.5 V, and the oscillation should be stable), reset is released.
After the reset is completed, the program starts from the address
contained in address FFFD 16 (high-order byte) and address
FFFC16 (low-order byte). Make sure that the reset input voltage is
less than 0.54 V for VCC of 2.7 V.
Poweron
RESET
VCC
Power source
voltage
0V
Reset input
voltage
0V
(Note)
0.2VCC
Note : Reset release voltage ; Vcc=2.7 V
RESET
VCC
Power source
voltage detection
circuit
Fig. 78 Reset circuit example
XIN
φ
RESET
Internal
reset
Address
?
?
?
?
FFFC
FFFD
ADH,L
Reset address from the vector table.
?
Data
?
?
?
ADL
ADH
SYNC
XIN: 10.5 to 18.5 clock cycles
Notes 1: The frequency relation of f(XIN) and f(φ) is f(XIN)=8 • f(φ).
2: The question marks (?) indicate an undefined state that depends on the previous state.
Fig. 79 Reset sequence
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 84 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Address Register contents
Address Register contents
(1)
Port P0 (P0)
000016
0016
(34) Timer Z (low-order) (TZL)
002816
FF16
(2)
Port P0 direction register (P0D)
000116
0016
(35) Timer Z (high-order) (TZH)
002916
FF16
(3)
Port P1 (P1)
000216
0016
(36) Timer Z mode register (TZM)
002A16
0016
(4)
Port P1 direction register (P1D)
000316
0016
(37) PWM control register (PWMCON)
002B16
0016
(5)
Port P2 (P2)
000416
0016
(38) PWM prescaler (PREPWM)
002C16 X X X X X X X X
(6)
Port P2 direction register (P2D)
000516
0016
(39) PWM register (PWM)
002D16 X X X X X X X X
(7)
Port P3 (P3)
000616
0016
(40) Baud rate generator 3 (BRG3)
002F16 X X X X X X X X
(8)
Port P3 direction register (P3D)
000716
0016
(41) Transmit/Receive buffer register 3 (TB3/RB3) 003016 X X X X X X X X
(9)
Port P4 (P4)
000816
0016
(42) Serial I/O3 status register (SIO3STS)
003116 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
(10) Port P4 direction register (P4D)
000916
0016
(43) Serial I/O3 control register (SIO3CON)
003216
(11) Port P5 (P5)
000A16
0016
(44) UART3 control register (SIO3CON)
003316 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0
(12) Port P5 direction register (P5D)
0016
000B16
0016
(45) AD/DA control register (ADCON)
003416 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
(13) Port P6 (P6)
000C16
0016
(46) A-D conversion register 1 (AD1)
003516 X X X X X X X X
(14) Port P6 direction register (P6D)
000D16
0016
(47) D-A1 conversion register (DA1)
003616
0016
(15)
Timer 12, X count source selection register (T12XCSS)
000E16 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1
(48) D-A2 conversion register (DA2)
003716
0016
(16)
Timer Y, Z count source selection register (TYZCSS)
000F16 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1
(49) A-D conversion register 2 (AD2)
003816 0 0 0 0 0 0 X X
(50) Interrupt source selection register (INTSEL)
003916
0016
0016
(17) MISRG
001016
(18) Transmit/Receive buffer register 1 (TB1/RB1)
001816 X X X X X X X X
(51) Interrupt edge selection register (INTEDGE)
003A16
(19) Serial I/O1 status register (SIO1STS)
001916 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
(52) CPU mode register (CPUM)
003B16 0 1 0 0 1 0 0 0
(20) Serial I/O1 control register (SIO1CON)
001A16
(53) Interrupt request register 1 (IREQ1)
003C16
0016
(21) UART1 control register (UART1CON)
001B16 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0
(54) Interrupt request register 2 (IREQ2)
003D16
0016
(22) Baud rate generator 1 (BRG1)
001C16 X X X X X X X X
(55) Interrupt control register 1 (ICON1)
003E16
0016
(23) Serial I/O2 control register (SIO2CON)
001D16
(56) Interrupt control register 2 (ICON2)
003F16
0016
(24) Watchdog timer control register (WDTCON)
001E16 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1
(57) Port P0 pull-up control register (PULL0)
0FF016
0016
(25) Serial I/O2 register (SIO2)
001F16 X X X X X X X X
(58) Port P1 pull-up control register (PULL1)
0FF116
0016
(26) Prescaler 12 (PRE12)
002016
FF16
(59) Port P2 pull-up control register (PULL2)
0FF216
0016
(27) Timer 1 (T1)
002116
0116
(60) Port P3 pull-up control register (PULL3)
0FF316
0016
(28) Timer 2 (T2)
002216
FF16
(61) Port P4 pull-up control register (PULL4)
0FF416
0016
(29) Timer XY mode register (TM)
002316
0016
(62) Port P5 pull-up control register (PULL5)
0FF516
0016
(30) Prescaler X (PREX)
002416
FF16
(63) Port P6 pull-up control register (PULL6)
0FF616
0016
(31) Timer X (TX)
002516
FF16
(64) Flash memory control register (FCON)
0FFE16
0016
(32) Prescaler Y (PREY)
002616
FF16
(65) Flash command register (FCMD)
0FFF16
0016
(33) Timer Y (TY)
002716
FF16
(66) Processor status register
(PS)
(67) Program counter
(PCH)
FFFD16 contents
(PCL)
FFFC16 contents
0016
0016
0016
Note : X : Not fixed
Since the initial values for other than above mentioned registers and
RAM contents are indefinite at reset, they must be set.
Fig. 80 Internal status at reset (3803 group)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 85 of 136
X X X X X 1 X X
3803/3804 Group
Address Register contents
Port P0 (P0)
000016
0016
(41) Timer Z (low-order) (TZL)
002816
FF16
(2)
Port P0 direction register (P0D)
000116
0016
(42) Timer Z (high-order) (TZH)
002916
FF16
(3)
Port P1 (P1)
000216
0016
(43) Timer Z mode register (TZM)
002A16
0016
(4)
Port P1 direction register (P1D)
000316
0016
(44) PWM control register (PWMCON)
002B16
0016
(5)
Port P2 (P2)
000416
0016
(45) PWM prescaler (PREPWM)
002C16 X X X X X X X X
(6)
Port P2 direction register (P2D)
000516
0016
(46) PWM register (PWM)
002D16 X X X X X X X X
(7)
Port P3 (P3)
000616
0016
(47) Baud rate generator 3 (BRG3)
002F16 X X X X X X X X
(8)
Port P3 direction register (P3D)
000716
0016
(48) Transmit/Receive buffer register 3 (TB3/RB3) 003016 X X X X X X X X
(9)
Port P4 (P4)
000816
0016
(49) Serial I/O3 status register (SIO3STS)
003116 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
(10) Port P4 direction register (P4D)
000916
0016
(50) Serial I/O3 control register (SIO3CON)
003216
(11) Port P5 (P5)
000A16
0016
(51) UART3 control register (SIO3CON)
003316 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0
(12) Port P5 direction register (P5D)
000B16
0016
(52) AD/DA control register (ADCON)
003416 0 0 0 0 1 0 0 0
(13) Port P6 (P6)
000C16
0016
(53) A-D conversion register 1 (AD1)
003516 X X X X X X X X
(14) Port P6 direction register (P6D)
000D16
0016
(54) D-A1 conversion register (DA1)
003616
0016
(15)
Timer 12, X count source selection register (T12XCSS)
000E16 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1
(55) D-A2 conversion register (DA2)
003716
0016
(16)
Timer Y, Z count source selection register (TYZCSS)
000F16 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1
(56) A-D conversion register 2 (AD2)
003816 0 0 0 0 0 0 X X
(57) Interrupt source selection register (INTSEL)
003916
0016
0016
(17) MISRG
001016
(18)
I 2C
0016
0016
001116 X X X X X X X X
(58) Interrupt edge selection register (INTEDGE)
003A16
(19) I2C special mode status register (S3)
001216 0 0 1 0 0 0 0 0
(59) CPU mode register (CPUM)
003B16 0 1 0 0 1 0 0 0
(20) I2C status register (S1)
001316 0 0 0 1 0 0 0 X
(60) Interrupt request register 1 (IREQ1)
003C16
0016
(21) I2C control register (S1D)
001416
0016
(61) Interrupt request register 2 (IREQ2)
003D16
0016
(22) I2C clock control register (S2)
001516
0016
data shift register (S0)
(62) Interrupt control register 1 (ICON1)
003E16
0016
(23) I2C START/STOP condition control register (S2D)001616 0 0 0 1 1 0 1 0
(63) Interrupt control register 2 (ICON2)
003F16
0016
(24) I2C special mode control register (S3D)
001716
(64) Port P0 pull-up control register (PULL0)
0FF016
0016
(25) Transmit/Receive buffer register 1 (TB1/RB1)
001816 X X X X X X X X
(65) Port P1 pull-up control register (PULL1)
0FF116
0016
(26) Serial I/O1 status register (SIO1STS)
001916 1 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
(66) Port P2 pull-up control register (PULL2)
0FF216
0016
(67) Port P3 pull-up control register (PULL3)
0FF316
0016
0016
(27) Serial I/O1 control register (SIO1CON)
001A16
(28) UART1 control register (UART1CON)
001B16 1 1 1 0 0 0 0 0
(68) Port P4 pull-up control register (PULL4)
0FF416
0016
(69) Port P5 pull-up control register (PULL5)
0FF516
0016
(70) Port P6 pull-up control register (PULL6)
0FF616
0016
0016
(29) Baud rate generator 1 (BRG1)
001C16
X XX X XX X X
(30) Serial I/O2 control register (SIO2CON)
001D16
0016
(31) Watchdog timer control register (WDTCON)
001E16 0 0 1 1 1 1 1 1
(71) I2C
slave address register 0 (S0D0)
0FF716
0016
(32) Serial I/O2 register (SIO2)
001F16 X X X X X X X X
(72) I2C slave address register 1 (S0D1)
0FF816
0016
(33) Prescaler 12 (PRE12)
002016
FF16
(73) I2C slave address register 2 (S0D3)
0FF916
0016
(34) Timer 1 (T1)
002116
0116
(74) Flash memory control register (FCON)
0FFE16
0016
(35) Timer 2 (T2)
002216
FF16
(75) Flash command register (FCMD)
0FFF16
(36) Timer XY mode register (TM)
002316
0016
(76) Processor status register
(PS)
(37) Prescaler X (PREX)
002416
FF16
(77) Program counter
(PCH)
FFFD16 contents
(38) Timer X (TX)
002516
FF16
(PCL)
FFFC16 contents
(39) Prescaler Y (PREY)
002616
FF16
(40) Timer Y (TY)
002716
FF16
Note : X : Not fixed
Since the initial values for other than above mentioned registers and
RAM contents are indefinite at reset, they must be set.
Fig. 81 Internal status at reset (3804 group)
Rev.4.01
Address Register contents
(1)
Nov 14, 2003
page 86 of 136
0016
X X X X X 1 X X
3803/3804 Group
CLOCK GENERATING CIRCUIT
The 3803/3804 group has two built-in oscillation circuits: main
clock XIN-XOUT oscillation circuit and sub clock XCIN-XCOUT oscillation circuit. An oscillation circuit can be formed by connecting a
resonator between XIN and XOUT (XCIN and XCOUT). Use the circuit constants in accordance with the resonator manufacturer’s
recommended values. No external resistor is needed between XIN
and XOUT since a feed-back resistor exists on-chip. However, an
external feed-back resistor is needed between XCIN and XCOUT.
Immediately after power on, only the XIN oscillation circuit starts
oscillating, and XCIN and XCOUT pins function as I/O ports.
Frequency Control
(1) Middle-speed mode
The internal clock φ is the frequency of XIN divided by 8. After reset is released, this mode is selected.
(2) High-speed mode
The internal clock φ is half the frequency of XIN.
(3) Low-speed mode
Oscillation Control
(1) Stop mode
If the STP instruction is executed, the internal clock φ stops at an
“H” level, and X IN and XCIN oscillators stop. When the oscillation
stabilizing time set after STP instruction released bit is “0,” the
prescaler 12 is set to “FF16” and timer 1 is set to “0116.” When the
oscillation stabilizing time set after STP instruction released bit is
“1,” set the sufficient time for oscillation of used oscillator to stabilize since nothing is set to the prescaler 12 and timer 1.
After STP instruction is released, the input of the prescaler 12 is
connected to count source which had set at executing the STP instruction, and the output of the prescaler 12 is connected to timer
1. Set the timer 1 interrupt enable bit to disabled (“0”) before executing the STP instruction. Oscillator restarts when an external
interrupt is received, but the internal clock φ is not supplied to the
CPU (remains at “H”) until timer 1 underflows. The internal clock φ
is supplied for the first time, when timer 1 underflows. Therefore
make sure not to set the timer 1 interrupt request bit to “1” before
the STP instruction stops the oscillator. When the oscillator is restarted by reset, apply “L” level to the RESET pin until the
oscillation is stable since a wait time will not be generated.
The internal clock φ is half the frequency of XCIN.
(2) Wait mode
(4) Low power dissipation mode
The low power consumption operation can be realized by stopping
the main clock XIN in low-speed mode. To stop the main clock, set
bit 5 of the CPU mode register to “1.” When the main clock XIN is
restarted (by setting the main clock stop bit to “0”), set sufficient
time for oscillation to stabilize.
If the WIT instruction is executed, the internal clock φ stops at an
“H” level, but the oscillator does not stop. The internal clock φ restarts when an interrupt is received. Since the oscillator does not
stop, normal operation can be started immediately after the clock
is restarted.
■Note
•If you switch the mode between middle/high-speed and lowspeed, stabilize both XIN and XCIN oscillations. The sufficient time
is required for the sub clock to stabilize, especially immediately
after power on and at returning from stop mode. When switching
the mode between middle/high-speed and low-speed, set the frequency on condition that f(XIN) > 3f(XCIN).
•When using the quartz-crystal oscillator of high frequency, such
as 16 MHz etc., it may be necessary to select a specific oscillator
with the specification demanded.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 87 of 136
3803/3804 Group
XCIN
XCOUT
Rf
CCIN
XIN
XOUT
Rd
CCOUT
CIN
COUT
Fig. 82 Ceramic resonator circuit
XCIN
XCOUT
XIN
XOUT
Open
Open
External oscillation
circuit
External oscillation
circuit
VCC
VSS
VCC
VSS
Fig. 83 External clock input circuit
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 88 of 136
3803/3804 Group
XCOUT
XCIN
“0”
“1”
Port XC
switch bit
XOUT
XIN
Main clock division ratio
selection bits (Note 1)
Low-speed
mode
1/2
Divider
Prescaler 12
1/4
High-speed or
middle-speed
mode
Timer 1
Reset or
STP instruction
(Note 2)
Main clock division ratio
selection bits (Note 1)
Middle-speed mode
Timing φ (internal clock)
High-speed or
low-speed mode
Main clock stop bit
Q
S
R
S Q
STP instruction
WIT instruction
R
Reset
Q S
R
STP instruction
Reset
Interrupt disable flag l
Interrupt request
Notes 1: Either high-speed, middle-speed or low-speed mode is selected by bits 7 and 6 of the CPU mode register.
When low-speed mode is selected, set port Xc switch bit (b4) to “1”.
2: f(XIN)/16 is supplied as the count source to the prescaler 12 at reset. The count source before executing the STP
instruction is supplied as the count source at executing STP instruction.
3: When bit 0 of MISRG is “0”, timer 1 is set “0116” and prescaler 12 is set “FF16” automatically. When bit 0 of MISRG is
“1”, set the appropriate value to them in accordance with oscillation stabilizing time required by the using oscillator
because nothing is automatically set into timer 1 and prescaler 12.
Fig. 84 System clock generating circuit block diagram (Single-chip mode)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 89 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Reset
C
“0 M4
CM ”←
“1 6 →“
1”
”←
→
“0
”
”
“0
→
CM ”←
0”
“1 M6 →“
C ”←
“1
4
CM7=0
CM6=0
CM5=0(8 MHz oscillating)
CM4=0(32 kHz stopped)
CM6
“1”←→“0”
C
“0 M7
CM ”←→
“1 6
“1
”←
”
→
“0
”
CM4
“1”←→“0”
CM4
“1”←→“0”
CM7=0
CM6=1
CM5=0(8 MHz oscillating)
CM4=0(32 kHz stopped)
Middle-speed mode
(f(φ)=1 MHz)
CM7=0
CM6=1
CM5=0(8 MHz oscillating)
CM4=1(32 kHz oscillating)
High-speed mode
(f(φ)=4 MHz)
C M6
“1”←→“0”
High-speed mode
(f(φ)=4 MHz)
CM7=0
CM6=0
CM5=0(8 MHz oscillating)
CM4=1(32 kHz oscillating)
CM7
“1”←→“0”
Middle-speed mode
(f(φ)=1 MHz)
Low-speed mode
(f(φ)=16 kHz)
CM5
“1”←→“0”
CM7=1
CM6=0
CM5=0(8 MHz oscillating)
CM4=1(32 kHz oscillating)
Low-speed mode
(f(φ)=16 kHz)
CM7=1
CM6=0
CM5=1(8 MHz stopped)
CM4=1(32 kHz oscillating)
b7
b4
CPU mode register
(CPUM : address 003B16)
CM4 : Port Xc switch bit
0 : I/O port function (stop oscillating)
1 : XCIN-XCOUT oscillating function
CM5 : Main clock (XIN- XOUT) stop bit
0 : Operating
1 : Stopped
CM7, CM6: Main clock division ratio selection bit
b7 b6
0 0 : φ = f(XIN)/2 ( High-speed mode)
0 1 : φ = f(XIN)/8 (Middle-speed mode)
1 0 : φ = f(XCIN)/2 (Low-speed mode)
1 1 : Not available
Notes 1 : Switch the mode by the allows shown between the mode blocks. (Do not switch between the modes directly without an allow.)
2 : The all modes can be switched to the stop mode or the wait mode and return to the source mode when the stop mode or the wait mode is
ended.
3 : Timer operates in the wait mode.
4 : When the stop mode is ended, a delay of approximately 1 ms occurs by connecting prescaler 12 and Timer 1 in middle/high-speed mode.
5 : When the stop mode is ended, a delay of approximately 0.25 s occurs by Timer 1 and Timer 2 in low-speed mode.
6 : Wait until oscillation stabilizes after oscillating the main clock XIN before the switching from the low-speed mode to middle/high-speed
mode.
7 : The example assumes that 8 MHz is being applied to the XIN pin and 32 kHz to the XCIN pin. φ indicates the internal clock.
Fig. 85 State transitions of system clock
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 90 of 136
3803/3804 Group
FLASH MEMORY MODE
Functional Outline (parallel input/output mode)
The 3803/3804 group has the flash memory mode in addition to
the normal operation mode (microcomputer mode). The user can
use this mode to perform read, program, and erase operations for
the internal flash memory.
The 3803/3804 group has three modes the user can choose: the
parallel input/output and serial input/output mode, where the flash
memory is handled by using the external programmer, and the
CPU reprogramming mode, where the flash memory is handled by
the central processing unit (CPU). The following explains these
modes.
In the parallel input/output mode, the 3803/3804 group allow the
user to choose an operation mode between the read-only mode
and the read/write mode (software command control mode) depending on the voltage applied to the VPP pin. When VPP = VPPL,
the read-only mode is selected, and the user can choose one of
three states (e.g., read, output disable, or standby) depending on
___ ___
___
inputs to the CE, OE, and WE pins. When VPP = VPPH, the read/
write mode is selected, and the user can choose one of four states
(e.g., read, output disable, standby, or write) depending on inputs
__ __
___
to the CE, OE, and WE pins. Table 17 shows assignment states of
control input and each state.
(1) Flash memory mode 1 (parallel I/O mode)
● Read
__
The microcomputer enters the read state by driving the CE, and
__
___
OE pins low and the WE pin high; and the contents of memory
corresponding to the address to be input to address input pins
(A0–A16) are output to the data input/output pins (D0–D7).
The parallel I/O mode can be selected by connecting wires as
shown in Figures 86, 87 and supplying power to the VCC and VPP
pins. In this mode, the M38039FF/M38049FF operates as an
equivalent of MITSUBISHI’s CMOS flash memory M5M28F101.
However, because the M38039FF/M38049FF’s internal memory
has a capacity of 60 Kbytes, programming is available for addresses 01000 16 to 0FFFF 16 , and make sure that the data in
addresses 00000 16 to 00FFF 16 and addresses 10000 16 to
1FFFF16 are FF16. Note also that the M38039FF/M38049FF does
not contain a facility to read out a device identification code by applying a high voltage to address input (A9). Be careful not to
erratically set program conditions when using a general-purpose
PROM programmer.
Table 16 shows the pin assignments when operating in the parallel input/output mode.
● Output disable
The microcomputer enters the output disable state by driving the
__
___
__
CE pin low and the WE and OE pins high; and the data input/output pins enter the floating state.
● Standby
__
The microcomputer enters the standby state by driving the CE pin
high. the 3803/3804 group is placed in a power-down state consuming only a minimum supply current. At this time, the data input/
output pins enter the floating state.
Table 16 Pin assignments of M38039FF/M38049FF when
operating in the parallel input/output mode
M38039FF/M38049FF
M5M28F101
VCC
VCC
VCC
VPP
VSS
CNVSS
VSS
VPP
VSS
Address input
Ports P0, P1, P31
A0–A16
Data I/O
Port P2
P36
D0–D7
__
CE
___
__
CE
__
P37
OE
___
OE
___
P33
WE
● Write
The microcomputer enters the write state by driving the VPP pin
___
__
high (VPP = VPPH) and then the WE pin low when the CE pin is
__
low and the OE pin is high. In this state, software commands can
be input from the data input/output pins, and the user can choose
program or erase operation depending on the contents of this software command.
WE
Table 17 Assignment states of control input and each state
Pin
Mode
State
Read
Read-only
Read/Write
__
___
OE
WE
VPP
Data I/O
VIL
VIL
VIH
VPPL
Output
Output disable
VIL
VIH
VIH
VPPL
Floating
Standby
VIH
×
×
VPPL
Floating
Read
VIL
VIL
VIH
VPPH
Output
Output disable
VIL
VIH
VIH
VPPH
Floating
Standby
Write
VIH
VIL
×
VIH
×
VIL
VPPH
VPPH
Floating
Input
Note: × can be VIL or VIH.
Rev.4.01
__
CE
Nov 14, 2003
page 91 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Table 18 Pin description (flash memory parallel I/O mode)
Name
Input
/Output
VCC, VSS
CNVSS
_____
RESET
XIN
XOUT
AVSS
VREF
P00–P07
P10–P17
P20–P27
P30–P37
Power supply
VPP input
Reset input
Clock input
Clock output
Analog supply input
Reference voltage input
Address input (A0–A7)
Address input (A8–A15)
Data I/O (D0–D7)
Control signal input
—
Input
Input
Input
Output
—
Input
Input
Input
I/O
Input
P40–P47
P50–P57
P60–P67
Input port P4
Input port P5
Input port P6
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
Pin
Input
Input
Input
page 92 of 136
Functions
Supply 5 V ± 10 % to VCC and 0 V to VSS.
Supply 5 V ± 10 % in read-only mode, supply 11.7 V to 12.6 V in read/write mode.
Connect to VSS.
Connect a ceramic resonator between XIN and XOUT.
Connect to VSS.
Connect to VSS.
Port P0 functions as 8-bit address input (A0–A7).
Port P1 functions as 8-bit address input (A8–A15).
–D7). ___
Function as 8-bit data’s I/O pins__
(D0__
P37, P36 and P33 function as the OE, CE and WE input pins respectively. P31 functions as
the A16 input pin. Connect P30 and P32 to VSS. Input “H” or “L” to P34, P35, or keep
them open.
Connect P44, P46 to VSS. Input “H” or “L” to P40 - P43, P45, P47, or keep them open.
Input “H” or “L”, or keep them open.
Input “H” or “L”, or keep them open.
A15
P17
33
A13
P16
A14
P15
35
34
A11
P14
36
A12
P13
37
A10
P12
38
A8
39
A9
P10/INT41
P11/INT01
40
41
A6
P07/AN15
42
A7
P06/AN14
43
A4
P05/AN13
44
A5
P03/AN11
P04/AN12
45
A3
P02/AN10
46
A1
P01/AN9
47
A2
P00/AN8
48
A0
3803/3804 Group
OE
P37
49
32
P20(LED0)
D0
CE
P36
50
31
P21(LED1)
D1
P35
51
30
P22(LED2)
D2
P34
52
29
P23(LED3)
D3
P33/(SCL✽2)
53
28
P24(LED4)
D4
P32/(SDA✽2)
54
27
P25(LED5)
D5
P31/DA2
55
26
P26(LED6)
D6
P30/DA1
56
25
P27(LED7)
D7
VCC
57
24
VSS
VREF
58
23
XOUT
14
15
16
P45/TXD1
P44/RXD1
P43/INT2
13
12
P46/SCLK1
11
P50/SIN2
P47/SRDY1
9
10
P52/SCLK2
P51/SOUT2
P42/INT1
7
17
8
18
64
P53/SRDY2
63
P63/AN3
P54/CNTR0
P64/AN4
RESET
CNVSS
6
P41/INT00/XCIN
19
P55/CNTR1
20
62
5
61
P65/AN5
4
P66/AN6
P57/INT3
P40/INT40/XCOUT
P56/PWM
XIN
21
3
22
60
P60/AN0
59
2
AVSS
P67/AN7
1
VCC
M38039FFFP/HP
M38049FFFP/HP
P61/AN1
A16
P62/AN2
WE
VSS
✽1
VPP
to the ceramic oscillation circuit.
* 12 :: Connect
3804 group
* indicates the flash memory pin.
Outline 64P6N-A/64P6Q-A
Fig. 86
Pin connectionwhen operating in parallel input/output mode (M38039FFFP/HP, M38049FFFP/HP)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 93 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Vcc
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
M38039FFSP
M38049FFSP
VSS
VCC
VREF
AVSS
P67/AN7
P66/AN6
P65/AN5
P64/AN4
P63/AN3
P62/AN2
P61/AN1
P60/AN0
P57/INT3
P56/PWM
P55/CNTR1
P54/CNTR0
P53/SRDY2
P52/SCLK2
P51/SOUT2
P50/SIN2
P47/SRDY1
P46/SCLK1
P45/TXD1
P44/RXD1
P43/INT2
P42/INT1
CNVSS
VPP
RESET
P41/INT00/XCIN
P40/INT40/XCOUT
XIN
✽1
XOUT
VSS
P30/DA1
P31/DA2
P32/(SDA✽2)
P33/(SCL✽2)
P34
P35
P36
P37
P00/AN8
P01/AN9
P02/AN10
P03/AN11
P04/AN12
P05/AN13
P06/AN14
P07/AN15
P10/INT41
P11/INT01
P12
P13
P14
P15
P16
P17
P20/(LED0)
P21/(LED1)
P22/(LED2)
P23/(LED3)
P24/(LED4)
P25/(LED5)
P26/(LED6)
P27/(LED7)
A16
WE
CE
OE
A0
A1
A2
A3
A4
A5
A6
A7
A8
A9
A10
A11
A12
A13
A14
A15
D0
D1
D2
D3
D4
D5
D6
D7
to the ceramic oscillation circuit.
* 12 :: Connect
3804 group
* indicates the flash memory pin.
Outline 64P4B
Fig. 87
Pin connection when operating in parallel input/output mode (M38039FFSP, M38049FFSP)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 94 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Read-only Mode
shown in Figure 88, and the M38039FF/M38049FF will output the
contents of the user’s specified address from data I/O pin to the
external. In this mode, the user cannot perform any operation
other than read.
The microcomputer enters the read-only mode by applying VPPL
to the VPP pin. In this mode, the user can input the address of a
memory location to be read and the control signals at the timing
VIH
Address
Valid address
VIL
tRC
VIH
CE
VIL
ta(CE)
VIH
OE
VIL
tWRR
tDF
VIH
WE
VIL
VOH
Data
ta(OE)
Floating
Floating
Dout
tCLZ
VOL
tDH
tOLZ
ta(AD)
Fig. 88 Read timing
Read/Write Mode
Table 19 shows the software commands and the input/output information in the first and the second cycles. The input address is
___
latched internally at the falling edge of the WE input; software
commands and other input data are latched internally at the rising
___
edge of the WE input.
The following explains each software command. Refer to Figures 89
to 91 for details about the signal input/output timings.
The microcomputer enters the read/write mode by applying VPPH
to the VPP pin. In this mode, the user must first input a software
command to choose the operation (e. g., read, program, or erase)
to be performed on the flash memory (this is called the first cycle),
and then input the information necessary for execution of the command (e.g, address and data) and control signals (this is called
the second cycle). When this is done, the M38039FF/M38049FF
executes the specified operation.
Table 19 Software command (Parallel input/output mode)
Symbol
Second cycle
First cycle
Address input
Data input
Address input
Data I/O
Read
×
0016
Read address
Read data (Output)
Program
×
4016
Program address
Program data (Input)
Program verify
×
C016
×
Verify data (Output)
Erase
×
2016
×
2016 (Input)
Verify address
A016
×
Verify data (Output)
×
×
FF16
9016
×
ADI
FF16 (Input)
DDI (Output)
Erase verify
Reset
Device identification
Note: ADI = Device identification address : manufacturer’s code 0000016, device code 0000116
DDI = Device identification data : manufacturer’s code 1C16, device code D016
X can be VIL or VIH.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 95 of 136
3803/3804 Group
● Read command
The microcomputer enters the read mode by inputting command
code “0016” in the first cycle. The command code is latched into
___
the internal command latch at the rising edge of the WE input.
When the address of a memory location to be read is input in the
second cycle, with control signals input at the timing shown in Figure 89, the M38039FF/M38049FF outputs the contents of the
specified address from the data I/O pins to the external.
The read mode is retained until any other command is latched into
the command latch. Consequently, once the M38039FF/M38049FF
enters the read mode, the user can read out the successive memory
contents simply by changing the input address and executing the
second cycle only. Any command other than the read command
must be input beginning from its command code over again each
time the user execute it. The contents of the command latch immediately after power-on is 0016.
VIH
Address
Valid address
VIL
tRC
tWC
VIH
CE
VIL
tCH
ta(CE)
tCS
VIH
OE
VIL
tRRW
tWP
tWRR
tDF
VIH
WE
VIL
ta(OE)
tDS
VIH
Data
VIL
tDH
tVSC
VPPH
VPP
VPPL
Fig. 89 Timings during reading
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
tOLZ
0016
page 96 of 136
tCLZ
ta(AD)
Dout
tDH
3803/3804 Group
● Program verify command
The microcomputer enters the program verify mode by inputting
command code “C016” in the first cycle. This command is used to
verify the programmed data after executing the program command. The command code is latched into the internal command
___
latch at the rising edge of the WE input. When control signals are
input in the second cycle at the timing shown in Figure 90, the
M38039FF/M38049FF outputs the programmed address’s contents to the external. Since the address is internally latched when
the program command is executed, there is no need to input it in
the second cycle.
● Program command
The microcomputer enters the program mode by inputting command code “4016” in the first cycle. The command code is latched
___
into the internal command latch at the rising edge of the WE input.
When the address which indicates a program location and data is
input in the second cycle, the M38039FF/M38049FF internally
___
latches the address at the falling edge of the WE input and the
___
data at the rising edge of the WE input. The M38039FF/
___
M38049FF starts programming at the rising edge of the WE input
in the second cycle and finishes programming within 10 µs as
measured by its internal timer. Programming is performed in units
of bytes.
Note: A programming operation is not completed by executing the
program command once. Always be sure to execute a program verify command after executing the program command.
When the failure is found in this verification, the user must repeatedly execute the program command until the pass. Refer
to Figure 92 for the programming flowchart.
Program verify
VIH
Program
address
Address
VIL
tAS
tWC
Program
tAH
VIH
CE
VIL
tCS
tCS
tCS
tCH
tCH
tCH
VIH
OE
VIL
tRRW
tWP
tWPH
tWP
tDP
tWP
tWRR
VIH
WE
VIL
tDS
tDS
tDS
VIH
4016
Data
VIL
DIN
tDH
C016
tDH
Dout
tDH
tVSC
VPPH
VPP
VPPL
Fig. 90 Input/output timings during programming (Verify data is output at the same timing as for read.)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 97 of 136
Verify data output
3803/3804 Group
● Erase command
The erase command is executed by inputting command code 2016
in the first cycle and command code 20 16 again in the second
cycle. The command code is latched into the internal command
___
latch at the rising edges of the WE input in the first cycle and in
the second cycle, respectively. The erase operation is initiated at
___
the rising edge of the WE input in the second cycle, and the
memory contents are collectively erased within 9.5 ms as measured by the internal timer. Note that data 0016 must be written to
all memory locations before executing the erase command.
Note: An erase operation is not completed by executing the erase
command once. Always be sure to execute an erase verify
command after executing the erase command. When the failure is found in this verification, the user must repeatedly execute the erase command until the pass. Refer to Figure 92
for the erase flowchart.
● Erase verify command
The user must verify the contents of all addresses after completing the erase command. The microcomputer enters the erase
verify mode by inputting the verify address and command code
A016 in the first cycle. The address is internally latched at the fall___
ing edge of the WE input, and the command code is internally
___
latched at the rising edge of the WE input. When control signals
are input in the second cycle at the timing shown in Figure 91, the
M38039FF/M38049FF outputs the contents of the specified address to the external.
Note: If any memory location where the contents have not been
erased is found in the erase verify operation, execute the operation of “erase → erase verify” over again. In this case,
however, the user does not need to write data 0016 to memory
locations before erasing.
Erase verify
VIH
Address
Erase
VIL
Verify
address
tAS
tWC
tAH
VIH
CE
VIL
tCS
tCS
tCS
tCH
tCH
tCH
VIH
OE
VIL
tRRW
tWP
tWPH
tWP
tDE
tWP
tWRR
VIH
WE
VIL
tDS
tDS
tDS
VIH
2016
Data
2016
A016
VIL
tVSC
tDH
tDH
tDH
VPPH
VPP
VPPL
Fig. 91 Input/output timings during erasing (Verify data is output at the same timing as for read.)
Rev.4.01
Dout
Verify data output
Nov 14, 2003
page 98 of 136
3803/3804 Group
● Reset command
The reset command provides a means of stopping execution of
the erase or program command safely. If the user inputs command
code FF16 in the second cycle after inputting the erase or program
command in the first cycle and again input command code FF16 in
the third cycle, the erase or program command is disabled (i.e.,
reset), and the 3803/3804 group is placed in the read mode. If the
reset command is executed, the contents of the memory does not
change.
● Device identification code command
By inputting command code 9016 in the first cycle, the user can
read out the device identification code. The command code is
latched into the internal command latch at the rising edge of the
___
WE input. At this time, the user can read out manufacture’s code
1C16 (i.e., MITSUBISHI) by inputting 0000016 to the address input
pins in the second cycle; the user can read out device code D016
(i. e., 1M-bit flash memory) by inputting 0000116.
These command and data codes are input/output at the same timing as for read.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 99 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Program
Erase
START
START
VCC = 5 V, VPP = VPPH
VCC = 5 V, VPP = VPPH
ADRS = first location
ALL
BYTES = 0016 ?
YES
X=0
NO
WRITE PROGRAM
COMMAND
4016
WRITE PROGRAM
DATA
DIN
PROGRAM
ALL BYTES = 0016
ADRS = first location
X=0
DURATION = 10 µs
X=X+1
WRITE PROGRAM-VERIFY
COMMAND
C016
WRITE ERASE
COMMAND
2016
WRITE ERASE
COMMAND
2016
DURATION = 9.5 ms
DURATION = 6 µs
YES
X=X+1
X = 25 ?
WRITE ERASE-VERIFY
COMMAND
NO
PASS
FAIL
VERIFY BYTE ?
DURATION = 6 µs
VERIFY BYTE ?
PASS
FAIL
YES
X = 1000 ?
NO
INC ADRS
A016
LAST ADRS ?
NO
YES
WRITE READ COMMAND
PASS
FAIL
VERIFY BYTE ?
0016
VERIFY BYTE ?
FAIL
PASS
VPP = VPPL
NO
INC ADRS
DEVICE
PASSED
DEVICE
FAILED
LAST ADRS ?
YES
WRITE READ COMMAND
0016
VPP = VPPL
DEVICE
PASSED
Fig. 92 Programming/Erasing algorithm flow chart
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 100 of 136
DEVICE
FAILED
3803/3804 Group
Table 20 DC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS (Ta = 25 °C, VCC = 5 V ± 10 %, unless otherwise noted)
Parameter
Symbol
Test conditions
Typ.
Max.
1
__
ISB1
ISB2
Limits
Min.
VCC = 5.5 V, CE = VIH
VCC supply current (at standby)
V
CC = 5.5 V,
__
CE = VCC ± 0.2 V
Unit
mA
100
µA
__
ICC1
VCC supply current (at read)
VCC = 5.5 V, CE = VIL,
tRC = 150 ns, IOUT = 0 mA
15
mA
ICC2
VCC supply current (at program)
VPP = VPPH
15
mA
ICC3
VCC supply current (at erase)
VPP = VPPH
15
mA
0≤VPP≤VCC
10
µA
VPP supply current (at read)
VCC<VPP≤VCC + 1.0 V
100
µA
IPP2
VPP supply current (at program)
VPP = VPPH
VPP = VPPH
100
30
µA
mA
IPP3
VPP supply current (at erase)
VPP = VPPH
VIL
“L” input voltage
0
VIH
“H” input voltage
2.0
VOL
“L” output voltage
IPP1
IOL = 2.1 mA
VOH1
VOH2
“H” output voltage
IOH = –400 µA
2.4
IOH = –100 µA
VCC –0.4
VPPL
VPP supply voltage (read only)
VCC
VPPH
VPP supply voltage (read/write)
11.7
30
mA
0.8
V
VCC
V
0.45
V
V
V
VCC + 1.0
V
12.6
V
12.0
AC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS (Ta = 25 °C, VCC = 5 V ± 10 %, unless otherwise noted)
Table 21 Read-only mode
Symbol
Parameter
Limits
Min.
Max.
150
tRC
Read cycle time
ta(AD)
Address access time
ta(CE)
CE access time
ta(OE)
OE access time
tCLZ
tOLZ
Output enable time (after CE)
__
Output enable time (after OE)
tDF
Output floating time (after OE)
Unit
ns
150
ns
150
ns
55
ns
__
__
__
0
0
ns
ns
__
__
35
ns
__
tDH
Output valid time (after CE, OE, address)
0
ns
tWRR
Write recovery time (before read)
6
µs
Table 22 Read/Write mode
Symbol
Parameter
tWC
Write cycle time
tAS
Address set up time
tAH
Limits
Min.
150
Max.
Unit
ns
0
ns
Address hold time
60
ns
tDS
Data setup time
50
ns
tDH
Data hold time
10
ns
tWRR
Write recovery time (before read)
6
µs
tRRW
Read recovery time (before write)
tCS
CE setup time
tCH
CE hold time
tWP
tWPH
Write pulse width
Write pulse waiting time
tDP
Program time
10
µs
tDE
Erase time
9.5
ms
tVSC
VPP setup time
1
µs
0
µs
20
ns
0
ns
60
20
ns
ns
__
__
Note: Read timing of Read/Write mode is same as Read-only mode.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 101 of 136
3803/3804 Group
__
(2) Flash memory mode 2 (serial I/O mode)
P11/INT01
P12
P13
P14
P15
P16
P17
39
37
36
35
34
33
P07/AN15
P06/AN14
42
P10/INT41
P05/AN13
43
40
P04/AN12
44
41
P02/AN10
P03/AN11
45
P01/AN9
46
P00/AN8
48
P37/SRDY3
49
32
P20(LED0)
P36/SCLK3
50
31
P21(LED1)
P35/TXD3
51
30
P22(LED2)
P34/RXD3
52
29
P23(LED3)
P33/(SCL✽2)
53
28
P24(LED4)
P32/(SDA✽2)
54
27
P25(LED5)
P31/DA2
55
26
P26(LED6)
P30/DA1
56
VCC
57
VREF
58
25
P27(LED7)
24
VSS
23
XOUT
XIN
AVSS
59
22
P67/AN7
60
21
P40/INT40/XCOUT
P66/AN6
61
20
P41/INT00/XCIN
RESET
15
16
P44/RXD1
P43/
INT2
VSS
✽1
Vpp
SDA
14
P45/TXD1
11
P50/SIN2
12
10
P51/SOUT2
13
9
P52/SCLK2
P46/SCLK1
8
P53/SRDY2
P47/SRDY1/CNTR2
7
P54/CNTR0
SCLK
6
BUSY
5
P56/PWM
P42/INT1
P55/CNTR1
17
4
64
P57/INT3
CNVSS
P63/AN3
3
18
P60/AN0
19
63
2
62
1
P65/AN5
P64/AN4
P61/AN1
VCC
M38039FFFP/HP
M38049FFFP/HP
P62/AN2
OE
47
The flash memory version of the 3803/3804 group has a function
to serially input/output the software commands, addresses, and
data required for operation on the internal flash memory (e. g.,
read, program, and erase) using only a few pins. This is called the
serial I/O (input/output) mode. This mode can be selected by driving the SDA (serial data input/output), SCLK (serial clock input ),
38
and OE pins high after connecting wires as shown in Figures 93,
94 and powering on the V CC pin and then applying VPPH to the
VPP pin.
In the serial I/O mode, the user can use six types of software commands: read, program, program verify, erase, erase verify and
error check.
Serial input/output is accomplished synchronously with the clock,
beginning from the LSB (LSB first).
to the ceramic oscillation circuit.
* 12 :: Connect
3804 group
* indicates the flash memory pin.
Outline 64P6N-A/64P6Q-A
Fig. 93 Pin connection when operating in serial I/O mode (M38039FFFP/HP, M38049FFFP/HP)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 102 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Vcc
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11
12
13
14
15
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31
32
M38039FFSP
M38049FFSP
VSS
VCC
VREF
AVSS
P67/AN7
P66/AN6
P65/AN5
P64/AN4
P63/AN3
P62/AN2
P61/AN1
P60/AN0
P57/INT3
P56/PWM
P55/CNTR1
P54/CNTR0
P53/SRDY2
P52/SCLK2
P51/SOUT2
P50/SIN2
BUSY P47/SRDY1/CNTR2
P46/SCLK1
SCLK
P45/TXD1
SDA
P44/RXD1
P43/INT2
P42/INT1
Vpp
CNVSS
RESET
P41/INT00/XCIN
P40/INT40/XCOUT
XIN
✽1
XOUT
VSS
64
63
62
61
60
59
58
57
56
55
54
53
52
51
50
49
48
47
46
45
44
43
42
41
40
39
38
37
36
35
34
33
P30/DA1
P31/DA2
P32/(SDA✽2)
P33/(SCL✽2)
P34/RXD3
P35/TXD3
P36/SCLK3
P37/SRDY3
P00/AN8
P01/AN9
P02/AN10
P03/AN11
P04/AN12
P05/AN13
P06/AN14
P07/AN15
P10/INT41
P11/INT01
P12
P13
P14
P15
P16
P17
P20/(LED0)
P21/(LED1)
P22/(LED2)
P23/(LED3)
P24/(LED4)
P25/(LED5)
P26/(LED6)
P27/(LED7)
to the ceramic oscillation circuit.
* 12 :: Connect
3804 group
* indicates the flash memory pin.
Outline 64P4B
Fig. 94 Pin connection when operating in serial I/O mode (M38039FFSP, M38049FFSP)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 103 of 136
OE
3803/3804 Group
Table 23 Pin description (flash memory serial I/O mode)
Name
Pin
Input
/Output
—
Functions
VCC, VSS
Power supply
CNVSS
VPP input
Input
Supply 11.7 V to 12.6 V.
Supply 5 V ± 10 % to VCC and 0 V to VSS.
RESET
Reset input
Input
Connect to VSS.
XIN
XOUT
Clock input
Clock output
Input
Output
AVSS
Analog supply input
VREF
Reference voltage input
Input
Input an arbitrary level between the range of VSS and VCC.
P00–P07
Input port P0
Input
Input “H” or “L”, or keep them open.
P10–P17
Input port P1
Input
Input “H” or “L”, or keep them open.
P20–P27
Input port P2
Input
Input “H” or “L”, or keep them open.
P30–P36
P37
P40–P43,
P45
Input port P3
Control signal input
Input
Input “H” or “L”, or keep them open.
Input
Input
OE input pin
P44
SDA I/O
P46
SCLK input
P47
BUSY output
Output
This pin is for BUSY signal output.
P50–P57
Input port P5
Input
Input “H” or “L”, or keep them open.
P60–P67
Input port P6
Input
Input “H” or “L”, or keep them open.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 104 of 136
_____
Input port P4
—
I/O
Input
Connect a ceramic resonator between XIN and XOUT.
Connect to VSS.
__
Input “H” or “L” to P40 - P43, P45, or keep them open.
This pin is for serial data I/O.
This pin is for serial clock input.
3803/3804 Group
Functional Outline (serial I/O mode)
In the first transfer, the user inputs the command code. This is followed by address input and data input/output according to the
contents of the command. Table 24 shows the software commands used in the serial I/O mode. The following explains each
software command.
In the serial I/O mode, data is transferred synchronously with the
clock using serial input/output. The input data is read from the
SDA pin into the internal circuit synchronously with the rising edge
of the serial clock pulse; the output data is output from the SDA
pin synchronously with the falling edge of the serial clock pulse.
Data is transferred in units of eight bits.
Table 24 Software command (serial I/O mode)
Number of transfers First command
Second
Third
Fourth
Command
code input
Read
Program
0016
4016
Read address L (Input)
Program address L (Input)
Program verify
C016
Verify data (Output)
—————
Erase
2016
2016 (Input)
—————
Erase verify
A016
Verify address L (Input)
Error check
8016
Error code (Output)
Read address H (Input)
Program address H (Input)
Read data (Output)
Program data (Input)
—————
—————
Verify address H (Input)
Verify data (Output)
—————
—————
__
● Read command
Input command code 0016 in the first transfer. Proceed and input
the low-order 8 bits and the high-order 8 bits of the address and
__
pull the OE pin low. When this is done, the 3803/3804 group reads
out the contents of the specified address, and then latchs it into
the internal data latch. When the OE pin is released back high and
serial clock is input to the SCLK pin, the read data that has been
latched into the data latch is serially output from the SDA pin.
tCH
tCH
SCLK
A0
SDA
A7
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 0
Command code input (0016) Read address input (L)
A8
A15
Read address input (H)
tCR
D0
tWR
tRC
Read data output
OE
Read
BUSY “L”
Note : When outputting the read data, the SDA pin is switched for output at the first falling edge of SCLK. The SDA pin is placed
in the floating state during the period of th(C-E) after the last rising edge of SCLK (at the 8th bit).
Fig. 95 Timings during reading
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 105 of 136
D7
3803/3804 Group
● Program command
Input command code 4016 in the first transfer. Proceed and input
the low-order 8 bits and the high-order 8 bits of the address and
then program data. Programming is initiated at the last rising edge
of the serial clock during program data transfer. The BUSY pin is
driven high during program operation. Programming is completed
within 10 µs as measured by the internal timer, and the BUSY pin
is pulled low.
tCH
Note : A programming operation is not completed by executing the
program command once. Always be sure to execute a program verify command after executing the program command.
When the failure is found in the verification, the user must repeatedly execute the program command until the pass in the
verification. Refer to Figure 92 for the programming flowchart.
tCH
tCH
SCLK
tPC
A0
SDA
0 0 0 0 0 0 1 0
Command code input (4016)
A7
A8
D0
A15
Program address input (L) Program address input (H)
D7
Program data input
OE
tWP
Program
BUSY
Fig. 96 Timings during programming
● Program verify command
Input command code C016 in the first transfer. Proceed and drive
__
the OE pin low. When this is done, the 3803/3804 group verifyreads the programmed address’s contents, and then latchs it into
__
the internal data latch. When the OE pin is released back high and
serial clock is input to the SCLK pin, the verify data that has been
latched into the data latch is serially output from the SDA pin.
SCLK
D0
SDA
0 0 0 0 0 0 1 1
Command code input (C016)
D7
Verify data output
tCRPV
tWR
tRC
OE
Verify read
BUSY
“L”
Note: When outputting the verify data, the SDA pin is switched for output at the first falling edge of SCLK. The SDA pin is placed
in the floating state during the period of th(C-E) after the last rising edge of SCLK (at the 8th bit).
Fig. 97 Timings during program verify
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 106 of 136
3803/3804 Group
● Erase command
Input command code 2016 in the first transfer and command code
20 16 again in the second transfer. When this is done, the 3803/
3804 group executes an erase command. Erase is initiated at the
last rising edge of the serial clock. The BUSY pin is driven high
during the erase operation. Erase is completed within 9.5 ms as
measured by the internal timer, and the BUSY pin is pulled low.
Note that data 0016 must be written to all memory locations before
executing the erase command.
Note: A erase operation is not completed by executing the erase
command once. Always be sure to execute a erase verify
command after executing the erase command. When the failure is found in the verification, the user must repeatedly execute the erase command until the pass in the verification.
Refer to Figure 92 for the erase flowchart.
tCH
SCLK
tEC
SDA
0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0
0 0 0 0 0 1 0 0
Command code input (2016) Command code input (2016)
“H”
OE
twE
BUSY
Erase
Fig. 98 Timings at erasing
● Erase verify command
The user must verify the contents of all addresses after completing the erase command. Input command code A0 16 in the first
transfer. Proceed and input the low-order 8 bits and the high-order
__
8 bits of the address and pull the OE pin low. When this is done,
the 3803/3804 group reads out the contents of the specified ad__
dress, and then latchs it into the internal data latch. When the OE
pin is released back high and serial clock is input to the SCLK pin,
tCH
the verify data that has been latched into the data latch is serially
output from the SDA pin.
Note: If any memory location where the contents have not been
erased is found in the erase verify operation, execute the operation of “erase → erase verify” over again. In this case,
however, the user does not need to write data 0016 to memory
locations before erasing.
tCH
SCLK
A0
SDA
A7
0 0 0 0 0 1 0 1
Command code input (A016) Verify address input (L)
A8
A15
Verify address input (H)
tCREV
D0
tWR
tRC
D7
Verify data output
OE
Verify read
BUSY “L”
Note : When outputting the verify data, the SDA pin is switched for output at the first falling edge of SCLK. The SDA pin is placed
in the floating state during the period of th(C-E) after the last rising edge of SCLK (at the 8th bit).
Fig. 99 Timings during erase verify
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 107 of 136
3803/3804 Group
● Error check command
Input command code 8016 in the first transfer, and the 3803/3804
group outputs error information from the SDA pin, beginning at the
next falling edge of the serial clock. If the LSB bit of the 8-bit error
information is 1, it indicates that a command error has occurred. A
command error means that some invalid commands other than
commands shown in Table 24 has been input.
When a command error occurs, the serial communication circuit
sets the corresponding flag and stops functioning to avoid an erroneous programming or erase. When being placed in this state, the
serial communication circuit does not accept the subsequent serial
clock and data (even including an error check command). Therefore, if the user wants to execute an error check command,
temporarily drop the VPP pin input to the VPPL level to terminate
the serial input/output mode. Then, place the 3803/3804 group
into the serial I/O mode back again. The serial communication circuit is reset by this operation and is ready to accept commands.
The error flag alone is not cleared by this operation, so the user
can examine the serial communication circuit’s error conditions
before reset. This examination is done by the first execution of an
error check command after the reset. The error flag is cleared
when the user has executed the error check command. Because
the error flag is undefined immediately after power-on, always be
sure to execute the error check command.
tCH
SCLK
E0
SDA
OE
0 0 0 0 0 0 0 1
Command code input (8016)
? ? ? ? ? ? ?
Error flag output
“H”
BUSY “L”
Note: When outputting the error flag, the SDA pin is switched for output at the first falling edge of the serial clock. The SDA pin is placed
in the floating state during the period of th(C-E) after the last rising edge of the serial clock (at the 8th bit).
Fig. 100 Timings at error checking
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 108 of 136
3803/3804 Group
DC ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS (Ta = 25 °C, VCC = 5 V ± 10 %, VPP = 11.7 V to 12.6 V, unless otherwise noted)
ICC, IPP-relevant standards during read, program, and erase are the same as in the parallel input/output mode. VIH, VIL, VOH, VOL, IIH, and
__
IIL for the SCLK, SDA, BUSY, OE pins conform to the microcomputer modes.
Table 25 AC Electrical characteristics
(Ta = 25 °C, VCC = 5 V ± 10 %, VPP = 11.7 V to 12.6 V, f(XIN) = 10 MHz, unless otherwise noted)
Limits
Parameter
Symbol
Min.
Max.
Unit
tCH
Serial transmission interval
500(Note 1)
ns
tCR
Read waiting time after transmission
500(Note 1)
ns
tWR
Read pulse width
400(Note 2)
ns
tRC
Transfer waiting time after read
500(Note 1)
tCRPV
tWP
Waiting time before program verify
Programming time
tPC
Transfer waiting time after programming
tCREV
Waiting time before erase verify
tWE
Erase time
tEC
Transfer waiting time after erase
tc(CK)
ns
6
10
500(Note 1)
µs
µs
ns
6
ns
9.5
ns
500(Note 1)
ns
SCLK input cycle time
250
ns
tw(CKH)
SCLK high-level pulse width
100
ns
tw(CKL)
SCLK low-level pulse width
100
ns
tr(CK)
SCLK rise time
20
ns
tf(CK)
td(C-Q)
SCLK fall time
SDA output delay time
20
0
th(C-Q)
SDA output hold time
th(C-E)
SDA output hold time (only the 8th bit)
tsu(D-C)
SDA input set up time
30
ns
th(C-D)
SDA input hold time
90
ns
90
0
150(Note 3) 250(Note 4)
Notes 1: When f(XIN) = 10 MHz or less, calculate the minimum value according to formula 1.
5000
× 106
f(XIN)
2: When f(XIN) = 10 MHz or less, calculate the minimum value according to formula 2.
Formula 1 :
4000
× 106
f(XIN)
3: When f(XIN) = 10 MHz or less, calculate the minimum value according to formula 3.
Formula 2 :
1500
× 106
f(XIN)
4: When f(XIN) = 10 MHz or less, calculate the minimum value according to formula 4
Formula 3 :
Formula 4 :
2500
f(XIN)
× 106
AC waveforms
tf(CK)
tc(CK)
tr(CK)
tw(CKL)
tw(CKH)
SCLK
th(C-Q)
td(C-Q)
th(C-E)
Test conditions for AC characteristics
SDA output
• Output timing voltage : VOL = 0.8 V, VOH = 2.0 V
tsu(D-C)
SDA input
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 109 of 136
th(C-D)
• Input timing voltage : VIL = 0.2 VCC, VIH = 0.8 VCC
ns
ns
ns
ns
3803/3804 Group
(3) Flash memory mode 3 (CPU reprogramming
mode)
The 3803/3804 group has the CPU reprogramming mode where a
built-in flash memory is handled by the central processing unit
(CPU).
In CPU reprogramming mode, the flash memory is handled by
writing and reading to/from the flash memory control register (see
Figure 101) and the flash command register (see Figure 102).
The CNVSS pin is used as the VPP power supply pin in CPU reprogramming mode. It is necessary to apply the power-supply voltage
of VPPH from the external to this pin.
Whether these operations have been completed or not is judged
by checking this flag after each command of erase and the program is executed.
Bits 4, 5 of the flash memory control register are the erase/program area select bits. These bits specify an area where erase and
program is operated. When the erase command is executed after
an area is specified by these bits, only the specified area is
erased. Only for the specified area, programming is enabled; for
the other areas, programming is disabled.
Figure 103 shows the CPU mode register bit configuration in the
CPU reprogramming mode.
Functional Outline (CPU reprogramming mode)
Figure 101 shows the flash memory control register bit configuration. Figure 102 shows the flash command register bit
configuration.
Bit 0 of the flash memory control register is the CPU reprogramming mode select bit. When this bit is set to “1” and V PPH is
applied to the CNVss/VPP pin, the CPU reprogramming mode is
selected. Whether the CPU reprogramming mode is realized or
not is judged by reading the CPU reprogramming mode monitor
flag (bit 2 of the flash memory control register).
Bit 1 is a busy flag which becomes “1” during erase and program
execution.
7
6
5
4
0
3
2
1
0
Flash memory control register
(FCON : address 0FFE16)
0
CPU reprogramming mode select bit (Note)
0 : CPU reprogramming mode is invalid. (Normal operation mode)
1 : When applying 0 V to CNVSS/VPP pin, CPU reprogramming mode is
invalid. When applying VPPH to CNVSS/VPP pin, CPU reprogramming mode is valid.
Erase/Program busy flag
0 : Erase and program are completed or not have been executed.
1 : Erase/program is being executed.
CPU reprogramming mode monitor flag
0 : CPU reprogramming mode is invalid.
1 : CPU reprogramming mode is valid.
Fix this bit to “0.”
Erase/Program area select bits
0 0 : Addresses 100016 to FFFF16 (total 60 Kbytes)
0 1 : Addresses 100016 to 7FFF16 (total 28 Kbytes)
1 0 : Addresses 800016 to FFFF16 (total 32 Kbytes)
1 1 : Not available
Fix this bit to “0.”
Not used (returns "0" when read)
Note: Bit 0 can be reprogrammed only when 0 V is applied to the CNVSS/VPP pin.
Fig. 101 Flash memory control register bit configuration
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 110 of 136
3803/3804 Group
● CPU reprogramming mode operation procedure
The operation procedure in CPU reprogramming mode is described below.
< Beginning procedure >
➀ Apply 0 V to the CNVss/VPP pin for reset release.
➁ Set the CPU mode register (see Figure 103).
➂ After CPU reprogramming mode control program is transferred to
internal RAM, jump to this control program on RAM. (The following operations are controlled by this control program).
➃ Set “1" to the CPU reprogramming mode select bit.
➄ Apply VPPH to the CNVSS/VPP pin.
➅ Wait till CNVSS/VPP pin becomes 12V.
➆ Read the CPU reprogramming mode monitor flag to confirm
whether the CPU reprogramming mode is valid.
➇ The operation of the flash memory is executed by software-command-writing to the flash command register .
Note: The following are necessary other than this:
•Control for data which is input from the external (serial I/O
etc.) and to be programmed to the flash memory
•Initial setting for ports etc.
•Writing to the watchdog timer
< Release procedure >
➀ Apply 0 V to the CNVSS/VPP pin.
➁ Wait till CNVSS/VPP pin becomes 0 V.
➂ Set the CPU reprogramming mode select bit to “0.”
Each software command is explained as follows.
● Read command
When “0016" is written to the flash command register, the 3803/
3804 group enters the read mode. The contents of the corresponding address can be read by reading the flash memory (For
instance, with the LDA instruction etc.) under this condition.
The read mode is maintained until another command code is written
to the flash command register. Accordingly, after setting the read
mode once, the contents of the flash memory can continuously be
read.
After reset and after the reset command is executed, the read
mode is set.
b7
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
Flash command register
(FCMD : address 0FFF16)
Writing of software command
<Software command name>
<Command code>
• Read command
“0016”
• Program command
“4016”
• Program verify command
“C016”
• Erase command
“2016” + “2016”
• Erase verify command
“A016”
• Reset command
“FF16” + “FF16”
Note: The flash command register is write-only register.
b0
1
0 0
CPU mode register
(CPUM : address 003B16)
Processor mode bits
b1 b0
0 0 : Single-chip mode
0 1 : Not available
1 X : Not available
Stack page selection bit
0 : 0 page
1 : 1 page
Fix this bit to “1”.
Port XC switch bit
0 : I/O port function (stop oscillating)
1 : XCIN–XCOUT oscillating function
Main clock (XIN–XOUT) stop bit
0 : Oscillating
1 : Stopped
Main clock division ratio selection bits
b7 b6
0 0 : φ = f(XIN)/2 (high-speed mode)
0 1 : φ = f(XIN)/8 (middle-speed mode)
1 0 : φ = f(XCIN)/2 (low-speed mode)
1 1 : Not available
Fig. 102 Flash command register bit configuration
Fig. 103 CPU mode register bit configuration in CPU rewriting
mode
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 111 of 136
3803/3804 Group
● Program command
When “4016” is written to the flash command register, the 3803/
3804 group enters the program mode.
Subsequently to this, if the instruction (for instance, STA or LDM
instruction) for writing byte data in the address to be programmed
is executed, the control circuit of the flash memory executes the
program. The erase/program busy flag of the flash memory control
register is set to “1” when the program starts, and becomes “0"
when the program is completed. Accordingly, after the write instruction is executed, CPU can recognize the completion of the
program by polling this bit.
The programmed area must be specified beforehand by the erase/
program area select bits.
During programming, watchdog timer stops with “FFFF16” set.
Note: A programming operation is not completed by executing the
program command once. Always be sure to execute a program verify command after executing the program command.
When the failure is found in this verification, the user must repeatedly execute the program command until the pass. Refer
to Figure 104 for the flow chart of the programming.
● Program verify command
When “C016" is written to the flash command register, the 3803/
3804 group enters the program verify mode. Subsequently to this,
if the instruction (for instance, LDA instruction) for reading byte
data from the address to be verified (i.e., previously programmed
address), the contents which has been written to the address actually is read.
CPU compares this read data with data which has been written by
the previous program command. In consequence of the comparison, if not agreeing, the operation of “program → program verify”
must be executed again.
● Erase command
When writing “2016” twice continuously to the flash command register, the flash memory control circuit performs erase to the area
specified beforehand by the erase/program area select bits.
Erase/program busy flag of the flash memory control register becomes “1” when erase begins, and it becomes “0" when erase
completes. Accordingly, CPU can recognize the completion of
erase by polling this bit.
Data “0016” must be written to all areas to be erased by the program and the program verify commands before the erase
command is executed.
During erasing, watchdog timer stops with “FFFF16” set.
Note: The erasing operation is not completed by executing the erase
command once. Always be sure to execute an erase verify
command after executing the erase command. When the failure is found in this verification, the user must repeatedly execute the erase command until the pass. Refer to Figure 104
for the erasing flowchart.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 112 of 136
● Erase verify command
When “A016" is written to the flash command register, the 3803/
3804 group enters the erase verify mode. Subsequently to this, if
the instruction (for instance, LDA instruction) for reading byte data
from the address to be verified, the contents of the address is
read.
CPU must erase and verify to all erased areas in a unit of address.
If the address of which data is not “FF16” (i.e., data is not erased)
is found, it is necessary to discontinue erasure verification there,
and execute the operation of “erase → erase verify” again.
Note: By executing the operation of “erase → erase verify” again
when the memory not erased is found. It is unnecessary to
write data “0016” before erasing in this case.
● Reset command
The reset command is a command to discontinue the program or
erase command on the way. When “FF16” is written to the command
register two times continuously after “4016” or “2016” is written to the
flash command register, the program, or erase command becomes
invalid (reset), and the 3803/3804 group enters the reset mode.
The contents of the memory does not change even if the reset command is executed.
DC Electric Characteristics
Note: The characteristic concerning the flash memory part are the
same as the characteristic of the parallel I/O mode.
AC Electric Characteristics
Note: The characteristics are the same as the characteristic of the
microcomputer mode.
3803/3804 Group
Program
Erase
START
START
ADRS = first location
ALL
BYTES = 0016 ?
YES
X=0
NO
WRITE PROGRAM
COMMAND
4016
WRITE PROGRAM
DATA
DIN
PROGRAM
ALL BYTES = 0016
ADRS = first location
X=0
WAIT 1µs
NO
ERASE PROGRAM
BUSY FLAG = 0
YES
X=X+1
WRITE ERASE
COMMAND
2016
WRITE ERASE
COMMAND
2016
WAIT 1µs
WRITE PROGRAM-VERIFY
COMMAND
C016
NO
ERASE PROGRAM
BUSY FLAG = 0
DURATION = 6 µs
YES
X=X+1
X = 25 ?
YES
WRITE ERASE-VERIFY
COMMAND
NO
PASS
FAIL
VERIFY BYTE ?
DURATION = 6 µs
VERIFY BYTE ?
PASS
A016
FAIL
YES
X = 1000 ?
INC ADRS
NO
LAST ADRS ?
NO
YES
WRITE READ COMMAND
PASS
FAIL
VERIFY BYTE ?
VERIFY BYTE ?
0016
FAIL
PASS
DEVICE
PASSED
DEVICE
FAILED
NO
INC ADRS
LAST ADRS ?
YES
WRITE READ COMMAND
DEVICE
PASSED
Fig. 104 Flowchart of program/erase operation at CPU reprogramming mode
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 113 of 136
0016
DEVICE
FAILED
3803/3804 Group
NOTES ON PROGRAMMING
Processor Status Register
The contents of the processor status register (PS) after a reset are
undefined, except for the interrupt disable flag (I) which is “1.” After a reset, initialize flags which affect program execution. In
particular, it is essential to initialize the index X mode (T) and the
decimal mode (D) flags because of their effect on calculations.
Interrupts
The contents of the interrupt request bits do not change immediately after they have been written. After writing to an interrupt
request register, execute at least one instruction before performing a BBC or BBS instruction.
Decimal Calculations
• To calculate in decimal notation, set the decimal mode flag (D)
to “1”, then execute an ADC or SBC instruction. After executing
an ADC or SBC instruction, execute at least one instruction before executing a SEC, CLC, or CLD instruction.
• In decimal mode, the values of the negative (N), overflow (V),
and zero (Z) flags are invalid.
Timers
If a value n (between 0 and 255) is written to a timer latch, the frequency division ratio is 1/(n+1).
Serial I/O
In clock synchronous serial I/O, if the receive side is using an external clock and it is to output the SRDY signal, set the transmit
enable bit, the receive enable bit, and the SRDY output enable bit
to “1.”
Serial I/O continues to output the final bit from the TXD pin after
transmission is completed. SOUT2 pin for serial I/O2 goes to high
impedance after transfer is completed.
When in serial I/Os 1 and 3 (clock-synchronous mode) or in serial
I/O2, an external clock is used as synchronous clock, write transmission data to the transmit buffer register or serial I/O2 register,
during transfer clock is “H.”
A-D Converter
The comparator uses capacitive coupling amplifier whose charge
will be lost if the clock frequency is too low.
Therefore, make sure that f(XIN) is at least on 500 kHz during an
A-D conversion.
Do not execute the STP instruction during an A-D conversion.
D-A Converter
The accuracy of the D-A converter becomes rapidly poor under
the VCC = 4.0 V or less condition; a supply voltage of VCC ≥ 4.0 V
is recommended. When a D-A converter is not used, set all values
of D-Ai conversion registers (i=1, 2) to “0016.”
Instruction Execution Time
Multiplication and Division Instructions
• The index X mode (T) and the decimal mode (D) flags do not affect the MUL and DIV instruction.
• The execution of these instructions does not change the contents of the processor status register.
Ports
The contents of the port direction registers cannot be read. The
following cannot be used:
• The data transfer instruction (LDA, etc.)
• The operation instruction when the index X mode flag (T) is “1”
• The instruction with the addressing mode which uses the value
of a direction register as an index
• The bit-test instruction (BBC or BBS, etc.) to a direction register
• The read-modify-write instructions (ROR, CLB, or SEB, etc.) to
a direction register.
Use instructions such as LDM and STA, etc., to set the port direction registers.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 114 of 136
The instruction execution time is obtained by multiplying the period of the internal clock φ by the number of cycles needed to
execute an instruction.
The number of cycles required to execute an instruction is shown
in the list of machine instructions.
The period of the internal clock φ is double of the X IN period in
high-speed mode.
3803/3804 Group
NOTES ON USAGE
Handling of Power Source Pins
In order to avoid a latch-up occurrence, connect a capacitor suitable for high frequencies as bypass capacitor between power
source pin (VCC pin) and GND pin (VSS pin), and between power
source pin (VCC pin) and analog power source input pin (AV SS
pin). Besides, connect the capacitor to as close as possible. For
bypass capacitor which should not be located too far from the pins
to be connected, a ceramic capacitor of 0.01 µF–0.1 µF is recommended.
Flash Memory Version
The CNVSS pin is connected to the internal memory circuit block
by a low-ohmic resistance, since it has the multiplexed function to
be a programmable power source pin (VPP pin) as well.
To improve the noise reduction, connect a track between CNVSS
pin and VSS pin or VCC pin with 1 to 10 kΩ resistance.
The mask ROM version track of CNVSS pin has no operational interference even if it is connected to Vss pin or Vcc pin via a
resistor.
Electric Characteristic Differences Between
Mask ROM and Flash Memory Version MCUs
There are differences in electric characteristics, operation margin,
noise immunity,
and noise radiation between Mask ROM and Flash Memory version MCUs due to the difference in the manufacturing processes.
When manufacturing an application system with the Flash
Memory version and then switching to use of the Mask ROM version, please perform sufficient evaluations for the commercial
samples of the Mask ROM version.
DATA REQUIRED FOR MASK ORDERS
The following are necessary when ordering a mask ROM production:
1.Mask ROM Confirmation Form ✽
2.Mark Specification Form ✽
3.Data to be written to ROM, in EPROM form (three identical copies)
✽ For the mask ROM confirmation and the mark specifications, ref e r t o t h e “ R e n e s a s Te c h n o l o g y ” H o m e p a g e ( h t t p : / /
www.renesas.com/en/rom).
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 115 of 136
3803/3804 Group
ELECTRICAL CHARACTERISTICS
Absolute maximum ratings
Table 27 Absolute maximum ratings
Symbol
Parameter
VCC
Power source voltageS
Input voltage P00–P07, P10–P17, P20–P27,
VI
P30, P31, P34–P37, P40–P47,
P50–P57, P60–P67, VREF
VI
Input voltage P32, P33
VI
Input voltage RESET, XIN
VI
Input voltage CNVSS (Mask ROM version)
Input voltage CNVSS (Flash memory version)
VI
Output voltage P00–P07, P10–P17, P20–P27,
VO
P30, P31, P34–P37, P40–P47,
P50–P57, P60–P67, XOUT
VO
Output voltage P32, P33
Pd
Power dissipation
Operating temperature
Topr
Storage temperature
Tstg
Note: In flat package, this value is 300 mW.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 116 of 136
Conditions
All voltages are based on VSS.
Output transistors are cut off.
Ta = 25 °C
Ratings
–0.3 to 6.5
Unit
V
–0.3 to VCC +0.3
V
–0.3 to 5.8
–0.3 to VCC +0.3
–0.3 to VCC +0.3
–0.3 to 13
V
V
V
V
–0.3 to VCC +0.3
V
–0.3 to 5.8
1000 (Note)
–20 to 85
–65 to 125
V
mW
°C
°C
3803/3804 Group
Recommended operating conditions
Table 28 Recommended operating conditions
(VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V, Ta = –20 to 85 °C, unless otherwise noted)
Symbol
VCC
VCC
VSS
VREF
AVSS
VIA
VIH
VIH
VIH
VIH
VIH
VIL
VIL
VIL
VIL
VIL
Rev.4.01
Parameter
f(XIN) ≤ 8.4 MHz
f(XIN) ≤ 12.5 MHz
f(XIN) ≤ 16.8 MHz
f(XIN) ≤ 12.5 MHz
f(XIN) ≤ 16.8 MHz
Power source voltage
(Mask ROM version)
Power source voltage
(flash memory version)
Power source voltage
Analog reference voltage (when A-D converter is used)
Analog reference voltage (when D-A converter is used)
Analog power source voltage
Analog input voltage
AN0–AN15
“H” input voltage
P00–P07, P10–P17, P20–P27, P30, P31, P34–P37,
P40–P47, P50–P57, P60–P67
“H” input voltage
P32, P33
“H” input voltage (when I2C-BUS input level is selected)
SDA, SCL
“H” input voltage (when SMBUS input level is selected)
SDA, SCL
“H” input voltage
RESET, XIN, XCIN, CNVSS
“L” input voltage
P00–P07, P10–P17, P20–P27, P30–P37, P40–P47,
P50–P57, P60–P67
“L” input voltage (when I2C-BUS input level is selected)
SDA, SCL
“L” input voltage (when SMBUS input level is selected)
SDA, SCL
“L” input voltage
RESET, CNVSS
“L” input voltage
XIN, XCIN
Nov 14, 2003
page 117 of 136
Min.
2.7
4.0
4.5
4.0
4.5
Limits
Typ.
5.0
5.0
5.0
5.0
5.0
0
Max.
5.5
5.5
5.5
5.5
5.5
Unit
V
V
AVSS
VCC
V
V
V
V
V
0.8VCC
VCC
V
0.8VCC
5.5
V
0.7VCC
5.5
V
1.4
5.5
V
0.8VCC
VCC
V
0
0.2VCC
V
0
0.3VCC
V
0
0.6
V
0.2VCC
0.16VCC
V
V
VCC
VCC
2.0
2.7
0
3803/3804 Group
Table 29 Recommended operating conditions
(VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V, Ta = –20 to 85 °C, unless otherwise noted)
Symbol
ΣIOH(peak)
ΣIOH(peak)
ΣIOL(peak)
ΣIOL(peak)
ΣIOL(peak)
ΣIOH(avg)
ΣIOH(avg)
ΣIOL(avg)
ΣIOL(avg)
ΣIOL(avg)
IOH(peak)
IOL(peak)
IOL(peak)
IOH(avg)
IOL(avg)
Parameter
“H” total peak output current
“H” total peak output current
“L” total peak output current
“L” total peak output current
“L” total peak output current
“H” total average output current
“H” total average output current
“L” total average output current
“L” total average output current
“L” total average output current
“H” peak output current
“L” peak output current
“L” peak output current
“H” average output current
“L” average output current
IOL(avg)
“L” average output current
f(XIN)
Main clock input oscillation
frequency (Note 4)
f(XCIN)
Limits
Min.
Typ.
P00–P07, P10–P17, P20–P27, P30, P31, P34–P37 (Note 1)
P40–P47, P50–P57, P60–P67 (Note 1)
P00–P07, P10–P17, P30–P37 (Note 1)
P20–P27 (Note 1)
P40–P47,P50–P57, P60–P67 (Note 1)
P00–P07, P10–P17, P20–P27, P30, P31, P34–P37 (Note 1)
P40–P47,P50–P57, P60–P67 (Note 1)
P00–P07, P10–P17, P30–P37 (Note 1)
P20–P27 (Note 1)
P40–P47,P50–P57, P60–P67 (Note 1)
P00–P07, P10–P17, P20–P27, P30, P31, P34–P37,
P40–P47, P50–P57, P60–P67 (Note 2)
P00–P07, P10–P17, P30–P37, P40–P47, P50–P57,
P60–P67 (Note 2)
P20–P27 (Note 2)
P00–P07, P10–P17, P20–P27, P30, P31, P34–P37,
P40–P47, P50–P57, P60–P67 (Note 3)
P00–P07, P10–P17, P30–P37, P40–P47, P50–P57,
P60–P67 (Note 3)
P20–P27 (Note 3)
Vcc = 4.5–5.5 V
Vcc = 4.0–4.5 V
32.768
Unit
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
mA
–10
mA
10
mA
20
mA
–5
mA
5
mA
10
16.8
mA
MHz
MHz
8.6Vcc–21,9
Vcc = 2.7–4.0 V
Sub-clock input oscillation frequency (Notes 4, 5)
Max.
–80
–80
80
80
80
–40
–40
40
40
40
3
41
Vcc–
26
13
MHz
50
kHz
Notes 1: The total output current is the sum of all the currents flowing through all the applicable ports. The total average current is an average value measured over 100 ms. The total peak current is the peak value of all the currents.
2: The peak output current is the peak current flowing in each port.
3: The average output current IOL(avg), IOH(avg) are average value measured over 100 ms.
4: When the oscillation frequency has a duty cycle of 50%.
5: When using the microcomputer in low-speed mode, set the sub-clock input oscillation frequency on condition that
f(XCIN) < f(XIN)/3.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 118 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Electrical characteristics
Table 30 Electrical characteristics
(VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = –20 to 85 °C, unless otherwise noted)
Symbol
VOH
VOL
Parameter
Limits
Test conditions
“H” output voltage
P00–P07, P10–P17, P20–P27,
P30, P31, P34–P37, P40–P47,
P50–P57, P60–P67 (Note 1)
IOH = –10 mA
VCC = 4.0–5.5 V
IOH = –1.0 mA
VCC = 2.7–5.5 V
“L” output voltage
P00–P07, P10–P17, P20–P27,
P30–P37, P40–P47, P50–P57,
P60–P67
IOL = 10 mA
VCC = 4.0–5.5 V
IOL = 1.6 mA
VCC = 2.7–5.5 V
Min.
Typ.
Max.
Unit
VCC–2.0
V
VCC–1.0
V
2.0
V
0.4
V
VT+–VT–
Hysteresis
CNTR0, CNTR1, CNTR2,
INT0–INT4
0.4
V
VT+–VT–
Hysteresis
RxD1, SCLK1, SIN2, SCLK2, RxD3,
SCLK3
0.5
V
VT+–VT–
Hysteresis
0.5
V
IIH
“H” input current
P00–P07, P10–P17, P20–P27,
P30–P37, P40–P47, P50–P57,
P60–P67
VI = VCC
(Pin floating. Pull-up
transistors “off”)
IIH
“H” input current
RESET, CNVSS
VI = VCC
IIH
“H” input current
XIN
VI = VCC
IIL
“L” input current
P00–P07, P10–P17, P20–P27,
P30–P37, P40–P47, P50–P57,
P60–P67
VI = VSS
(Pin floating. Pull-up
transistors “off”)
IIL
“L” input current
RESET,CNVSS
VI = VSS
IIL
“L” input current
XIN
VI = VSS
IIL
“L” input current (at Pull-up)
P00–P07, P10–P17, P20–P27,
P30, P31, P34–P37, P40–P47,
P50–P57, P60–P67
VI = VSS
VCC = 5.0 V
VI = VSS
VCC = 3.0 V
RAM hold voltage
When clock stopped
VRAM
RESET
5.0
µA
5.0
µA
µA
–5.0
µA
–5.0
µA
µA
4
–4
–80
–210
–420
µA
–30
–70
–140
µA
2.0
5.5
V
Note 1: P35 is measured when the P35/TxD3 P-channel output disable bit of the UART3 control register (bit 4 of address 003316) is “0”.
P45 is measured when the P45/TxD1 P-channel output disable bit of the UART1 control register (bit 4 of address 001B16) is “0”.
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 119 of 136
3803/3804 Group
Table 31 Electrical characteristics (flash memory version)
(VCC = 4.0 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = –20 to 85 °C, unless otherwise noted)
Limits
Symbol
Parameter
Test conditions
High-speed mode
f(XIN) = 16.8 MHz
f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz
Output transistors “off”
High-speed mode
f(XIN) = 12.5 MHz
f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz
Output transistors “off”
High-speed mode
f(XIN) = 8.4 MHz
f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz
Output transistors “off”
ICC
Power source current
High-speed mode
f(XIN) = 16.8 MHz (in WIT state)
f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz
Output transistors “off”
Low-speed mode
f(XIN) = stopped
f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz
Output transistors “off”
Low-speed mode
f(XIN) = stopped
f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz (in WIT state)
Output transistors “off”
Middle-speed mode
f(XIN) = 16.8 MHz
f(XCIN) = stopped
Output transistors “off”
Middle-speed mode
f(XIN) = 16.8 MHz (in WIT state)
f(XCIN) = stopped
Output transistors “off”
Increment when A-D conversion is
executed
f(XIN) = 16.8 MHz
All oscillation stopped
(in STP state)
Output transistors “off”
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 120 of 136
Ta = 25 °C
Ta = 85 °C
Min.
Unit
Typ.
Max.
12
22
mA
10
18
mA
7
13.5
mA
3.5
6
mA
60
200
µA
30
60
µA
6
12
mA
3
5.5
mA
µA
500
0.1
1.0
µA
10
µA
3803/3804 Group
Table 32 Electrical characteristics (mask ROM version)
(VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = –20 to 85 °C, unless otherwise noted)
Limits
Symbol
Parameter
Test conditions
Max.
8
15
mA
6.5
12
mA
5
9
mA
2
3.6
mA
55
200
µA
40
70
µA
Low-speed mode (VCC = 3 V)
f(XIN) = stopped
f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz
Output transistors “off”
15
40
µA
Low-speed mode (VCC = 3 V)
f(XIN) = stopped
f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz (in WIT state)
Output transistors “off”
8
15
µA
Middle-speed mode
f(XIN) = 16.8 MHz
f(XCIN) = stopped
Output transistors “off”
4
7
mA
Middle-speed mode
f(XIN) = 16.8 MHz (in WIT state)
f(XCIN) = stopped
Output transistors “off”
1.8
3.3
mA
Increment when A-D conversion is
executed
f(XIN) = 16.8 MHz
500
High-speed mode
f(XIN) = 16.8 MHz
f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz
Output transistors “off”
High-speed mode
f(XIN) = 12.5 MHz
f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz
Output transistors “off”
High-speed mode
f(XIN) = 8.4 MHz
f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz
Output transistors “off”
High-speed mode
f(XIN) = 16.8 MHz (in WIT state)
f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz
Output transistors “off”
ICC
Power source current
Low-speed mode
f(XIN) = stopped
f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz
Output transistors “off”
Low-speed mode
f(XIN) = stopped
f(XCIN) = 32.768 kHz (in WIT state)
Output transistors “off”
All oscillation stopped
(in STP state)
Output transistors “off”
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 121 of 136
Unit
Typ.
Ta = 25 °C
Ta = 85 °C
Min.
0.1
µA
1.0
µA
10
µA
3803/3804 Group
A-D converter characteristics
Table 33 A-D converter characteristics (1)
(VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.0 V to VCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Ta = –20 to 85 °C, unless otherwise noted)
10-bit A-D mode (when conversion mode selection bit (bit 7 of address 003816) is “0”)
Symbol
Parameter
–
Resolution
Absolute accuracy (excluding quantization error)
–
tCONV
Conversion time
RLADDER
Ladder resistor
IVREF
Reference power
source input current
II(AD)
A-D port input current
Test conditions
Limits
Min.
Typ.
Max.
10
VCC = VREF = 5.0 V
at A-D converter operated
VREF = 5.0 V
at A-D converter stopped
VREF = 5.0 V
Unit
±4
bit
LSB
61
2tc(XIN)
12
35
100
kΩ
50
150
200
5
µA
5.0
µA
µA
Table 34 A-D converter characteristics (2)
(VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.0 V to VCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Ta = –20 to 85 °C, unless otherwise noted)
8-bit A-D mode (when conversion mode selection bit (bit 7 of address 003816) is “1”)
Symbol
Parameter
–
Resolution
–
Absolute accuracy (excluding quantization error)
tCONV
Conversion time
RLADDER
Ladder resistor
IVREF
Reference power
source input current
II(AD)
A-D port input current
at A-D converter operated
at A-D converter stopped
Test conditions
Limits
Min.
Typ.
VCC = VREF = 5.0 V
VREF = 5.0 V
VREF = 5.0 V
Max.
Unit
8
bit
±2
LSB
50
2tc(XIN)
12
35
100
kΩ
50
150
200
5
µA
µA
5.0
µA
D-A converter characteristics
Table 35 D-A converter characteristics
(VCC = 2.7 to 5.5 V, VREF = 2.7 V to VCC, VSS = AVSS = 0 V, Ta = –20 to 85 °C, unless otherwise noted)
Symbol
–
–
tsu
RO
IVREF
Parameter
Test conditions
Limits
Min.
Resolution
Absolute accuracy
Unit
8
Bits
1.0
%
2.7 ≤ VREF < 4.0 V
2.5
%
3
5
µs
kΩ
3.2
mA
Setting time
Output resistor
2
Reference power source input current (Note 1)
Nov 14, 2003
Max.
4.0 ≤ VREF ≤ 5.5 V
Note 1: Using one D-A converter, with the value in the D-A conversion register of the other D-A converter being “0016”.
Rev.4.01
Typ.
page 122 of 136
3.5
3803/3804 Group
Timing requirements and switching characteristics
Table 36 Timing requirements (1)
(VCC = 4.0 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = –20 to 85 °C, unless otherwise noted)
Symbol
tW(RESET)
Limits
Parameter
Min.
Reset input “L” pulse width
Main clock input cycle time (Vcc = 4.5–5.5 V)
Main clock input cycle time (Vcc = 4.0–4.5 V)
Main clock input “H” pulse width (Vcc = 4.5–5.5 V)
tWH(XIN)
Main clock input “H” pulse width (Vcc = 4.0–4.5 V)
Main clock input “L” pulse width (Vcc = 4.0–4.5 V)
Unit
16
XIN cycle
ns
86Vcc–219
25
4000
86Vcc–219
25
Main clock input “L” pulse width (Vcc = 4.5–5.5 V)
tWL(XIN)
Max.
59.5
10000
tC(XIN)
Typ.
4000
86Vcc–219
ns
ns
ns
ns
ns
tC(XCIN)
Sub-clock input cycle time
20
µs
tWH(XCIN)
tWL(XCIN)
Sub-clock input “H” pulse width
5
µs
Sub-clock input “L” pulse width
5
µs
tC(CNTR)
CNTR0–CNTR2 input cycle time
ns
tWH(CNTR)
CNTR0–CNTR2 input “H” pulse width
200
80
tWL(CNTR)
80
ns
tWH(INT)
CNTR0–CNTR2 input “L” pulse width
INT00, INT01, INT1, INT2, INT3, INT40, INT41 input “H” pulse width
80
ns
tWL(INT)
INT00, INT01, INT1, INT2, INT3, INT40, INT41 input “L” pulse width
80
ns
tC(SCLK1), tC(SCLK3)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 clock input cycle time (Note)
800
tWH(SCLK1), tWH(SCLK3)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 clock input “H” pulse width (Note)
370
ns
ns
tWL(SCLK1), tWL(SCLK3)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 clock input “L” pulse width (Note)
370
ns
tsu(RxD1-SCLK1),
tsu(RxD3-SCLK3)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 input setup time
220
ns
th(SCLK1-RxD1),
th(SCLK3-RxD3)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 input hold time
100
ns
tC(SCLK2)
Serial I/O2 clock input cycle time
1000
ns
ns
tWL(SCLK2)
Serial I/O2 clock input “H” pulse width
Serial I/O2 clock input “L” pulse width
400
400
ns
tsu(SIN2-SCLK2)
Serial I/O2 input setup time
200
th(SCLK2-SIN2)
Serial I/O2 input hold time
200
ns
ns
tWH(SCLK2)
Note : When bit 6 of address 001A16 and bit 6 of address 003216 are “1” (clock synchronous).
Divide this value by four when bit 6 of address 001A16 and bit 6 of address 003216 are “0” (UART).
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 123 of 136
ns
3803/3804 Group
Table 37 Timing requirements (2)
(VCC = 2.7 to 4.0 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = –20 to 85 °C, unless otherwise noted)
Symbol
tW(RESET)
Parameter
Reset input “L” pulse width
tC(XIN)
Main clock input cycle time
tWH(XIN)
Main clock input “H” pulse width
tWL(XIN)
Main clock input “L” pulse width
Limits
Min.
16
26 ✕ 103
82Vcc–3
10000
82Vcc–3
Typ.
Max.
Unit
XIN cycle
ns
ns
10000
82Vcc–3
ns
tC(XCIN)
Sub-clock input cycle time
20
µs
tWH(XCIN)
Sub-clock input “H” pulse width
5
µs
tWL(XCIN)
tC(CNTR)
Sub-clock input “L” pulse width
5
µs
CNTR0–CNTR2 input cycle time
500
ns
tWH(CNTR)
CNTR0–CNTR2 input “H” pulse width
230
ns
tWL(CNTR)
CNTR0–CNTR2 input “L” pulse width
230
ns
tWH(INT)
INT00, INT01, INT1, INT2, INT3, INT40, INT41 input “H” pulse width
ns
tWL(INT)
INT00, INT01, INT1, INT2, INT3, INT40, INT41 input “L” pulse width
230
230
tC(SCLK1), tC(SCLK3)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 clock input cycle time (Note)
2000
ns
tWH(SCLK1), tWH(SCLK3)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 clock input “H” pulse width (Note)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 clock input “L” pulse width (Note)
950
950
ns
ns
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 input setup time
400
ns
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 input hold time
200
ns
tC(SCLK2)
Serial I/O2 clock input cycle time
2000
ns
tWH(SCLK2)
Serial I/O2 clock input “H” pulse width
ns
tWL(SCLK2)
Serial I/O2 clock input “L” pulse width
950
950
tsu(SIN2-SCLK2)
Serial I/O2 input setup time
400
ns
th(SCLK2-SIN2)
Serial I/O2 input hold time
300
ns
tWL(SCLK1), tWL(SCLK3)
tsu(RxD1-SCLK1),
tsu(RxD3-SCLK3)
th(SCLK1-RxD1),
th(SCLK3-RxD3)
Note : When bit 6 of address 001A16 is “1” (clock synchronous).
Divide this value by four when bit 6 of address 001A16 is “0” (UART).
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 124 of 136
ns
ns
3803/3804 Group
Table 38 Switching characteristics 1
(VCC = 4.0 to 5.5 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = –20 to 85 °C, unless otherwise noted)
Parameter
Symbol
Test
conditions
Limits
Typ.
Min.
Max.
Unit
tWH (SCLK1),
tWH (SCLK3)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 clock output “H” pulse width
tC(SCLK1)/2–30
tC(SCLK3)/2–30
ns
tWL (SCLK1),
tWL (SCLK3)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 clock output “L” pulse width
tC(SCLK1)/2–30
tC(SCLK3)/2–30
ns
td (SCLK1-TXD1) ,
td (SCLK3-TXD3)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 output delay time (Note 1)
tv (SCLK1-TXD1) ,
tv (SCLK3-TXD3)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 output valid time (Note 1)
tr (SCLK1) , tr (SCLK3) Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 clock output rising time
tf (SCLK1), tf (SCLK3) Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 clock output falling time
140
–30
ns
ns
Fig. 105
30
ns
30
ns
tWH (SCLK2)
Serial I/O2 clock output “H” pulse width
tC(SCLK2)/2–160
tWL (SCLK2)
Serial I/O2 clock output “L” pulse width
tC(SCLK2)/2–160
td (SCLK2-SOUT2)
Serial I/O2 output delay time
tV (SCLK2-SOUT2)
tf (SCLK2)
Serial I/O2 output valid time
Serial I/O2 clock output falling time
tr (CMOS)
CMOS output rising time (Note 2)
10
30
ns
ns
tf (CMOS)
CMOS output falling time (Note 2)
10
30
ns
Typ.
Max.
ns
ns
200
0
ns
ns
30
Notes 1: When the P45/TXD1 P-channel output disable bit of the UART1 control register (bit 4 of address 001B16) is “0”.
When the P35/TX D3 P-channel output disable bit of the UART3 control register (bit 4 of address 003316) is “0”.
2: The XOUT pin is excluded.
Table 39 Switching characteristics 2
(VCC = 2.7 to 4.0 V, VSS = 0 V, Ta = –20 to 85 °C, unless otherwise noted)
Parameter
Symbol
Test
conditions
Limits
Min.
Unit
tWH (SCLK1),
tWH (SCLK3)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 clock output “H” pulse width
tC(SCLK1)/2–50
tC(SCLK3)/2–50
ns
tWL (SCLK1),
tWL (SCLK3)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 clock output “L” pulse width
tC(SCLK1)/2–50
tC(SCLK3)/2–50
ns
td (SCLK1-TXD1) ,
td (SCLK3-TXD3)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 output delay time (Note 1)
tv (SCLK1-TXD1) ,
tv (SCLK3-TXD3)
Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 output valid time (Note 1)
tr (SCLK1) , tr (SCLK3) Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 clock output rising time
tf (SCLK1), tf (SCLK3) Serial I/O1, serial I/O3 clock output falling time
350
–30
Serial I/O2 clock output “H” pulse width
tC(SCLK2)/2–240
tWL (SCLK2)
Serial I/O2 clock output “L” pulse width
tC(SCLK2)/2–240
td (SCLK2-SOUT2)
Serial I/O2 output delay time
tV (SCLK2-SOUT2)
tf (SCLK2)
Serial I/O2 output valid time
Serial I/O2 clock output falling time
tr (CMOS)
CMOS output rising time (Note 2)
tf (CMOS)
CMOS output falling time (Note 2)
Nov 14, 2003
page 125 of 136
50
ns
50
ns
ns
ns
400
ns
50
ns
ns
20
50
ns
20
50
ns
0
Notes 1: When the P45/TXD1 P-channel output disable bit of the UART1 control register (bit 4 of address 001B16) is “0”.
When the P35/TX D3 P-channel output disable bit of the UART3 control register (bit 4 of address 003316) is “0”.
2: The XOUT pin is excluded.
Rev.4.01
ns
Fig. 105
tWH (SCLK2)
ns
3803/3804 Group
1kΩ
Measurement output pin
Measurement output pin
100pF
CMOS output
Fig. 105 Circuit for measuring output switching characteristics (1)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 126 of 136
100pF
N-channel open–drain output
Fig. 106 Circuit for measuring output switching characteristics (2)
3803/3804 Group
Timing diagram in single-chip mode
tC(CNTR)
tWL(CNTR)
tWH(CNTR)
CNTR0, CNTR1, CNTR2
INT1, INT2, INT3
INT00, INT40
INT01, INT41
0.8VCC
0.2VCC
tWL(INT)
tWH(INT)
0.8VCC
0.2VCC
tW(RESET)
RESET
0.8VCC
0.2VCC
tC(XIN)
tWL(XIN)
tWH(XIN)
0.8VCC
XIN
0.2VCC
tC(XCIN)
tWL(XCIN)
tWH(XCIN)
XCIN
0.8VCC
0.2VCC
tC(SCLK1), tC(SCLK2), tC(SCLK3)
tf tWL(SCLK1), tWL(SCLK2), tWL(SCLK3) tr tWH(SCLK1), tWH(SCLK2), tWH(SCLK3)
SCLK1
SCLK2
SCLK3
RXD1
RXD3
SIN2
0.8VCC
0.2VCC
tsu(RxD1-SCLK1),
tsu(SIN2-SCLK2),
tsu(RxD3-SCLK3)
th(SCLK1-RxD1),
th(SCLK2-SIN2),
th(SCLK3-RxD3)
0.8VCC
0.2VCC
td(SCLK1-TXD1),td(SCLK2-SOUT2),td(SCLK3-TXD3)
TXD1
TXD3
SOUT2
Fig. 107 Timing diagram (in single-chip mode)
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 127 of 136
tv(SCLK1-TXD1),
tv(SCLK2-SOUT2),
tv(SCLK3-TXD3)
3803/3804 Group
Table 40 Multi-master I2C-BUS bus line characteristics
Standard clock mode High-speed clock mode
Symbol
Parameter
Min.
Max.
Max.
Unit
tBUF
Bus free time
4.7
Min.
1.3
tHD;STA
Hold time for START condition
4.0
0.6
tLOW
Hold time for SCL clock = “0”
4.7
tR
Rising time of both SCL and SDA signals
tHD;DAT
Data hold time
tHIGH
Hold time for SCL clock = “1”
tF
Falling time of both SCL and SDA signals
tSU;DAT
Data setup time
250
100
ns
tSU;STA
Setup time for repeated START condition
4.7
0.6
µs
tSU;STO
Setup time for STOP condition
4.0
0.6
µs
µs
µs
µs
1.3
20+0.1Cb
300
ns
0
0
0.9
µs
4.0
0.6
1000
300
µs
20+0.1Cb
300
ns
Note: Cb = total capacitance of 1 bus line
SDA
tHD:STA
tBUF
tLOW
SCL
P
tR
tF
S
tHD:STA
Sr
tHD:DAT
tsu:STO
tHIGH
tsu:DAT
P
tsu:STA
S : START condition
Sr: RESTART condition
P : STOP condition
Fig. 108 Timing diagram of multi-master I2C-BUS
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 128 of 136
3803/3804 Group
PACKAGE OUTLINE
64P6N-A
Plastic 64pin 14✕14mm body QFP
EIAJ Package Code
QFP64-P-1414-0.80
Weight(g)
1.11
Lead Material
Alloy 42
MD
e
JEDEC Code
–
HD
ME
D
b2
49
64
1
48
I2
HE
E
Recommended Mount Pad
Symbol
33
16
A
32
L1
c
A2
17
F
e
A1
b
L
y
64P6Q-A
Detail F
MMP
b2
I2
MD
ME
Plastic 64pin 10✕10mm body LQFP
Weight(g)
–
Lead Material
Cu Alloy
MD
ME
JEDEC Code
–
e
EIAJ Package Code
LQFP64-P-1010-0.50
A
A1
A2
b
c
D
E
e
HD
HE
L
L1
y
b2
HD
D
64
49
1
I2
Recommended Mount Pad
48
A
A1
A2
b
c
D
E
e
HD
HE
L
L1
Lp
HE
E
Symbol
33
16
17
32
A
F
e
L
M
Detail F
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 129 of 136
Lp
c
A1
x
A3
A2
L1
y
b
Dimension in Millimeters
Max
Nom
Min
–
3.05
–
0.2
0.1
0
–
–
2.8
0.45
0.35
0.3
0.2
0.15
0.13
14.2
14.0
13.8
14.2
14.0
13.8
–
0.8
–
17.1
16.8
16.5
17.1
16.8
16.5
0.8
0.6
0.4
1.4
–
–
–
0.1
–
–
10°
0°
–
0.5
–
–
–
1.3
–
14.6
–
–
14.6
–
A3
x
y
b2
I2
MD
ME
Dimension in Millimeters
Min
Nom
Max
–
–
1.7
0.1
0.2
0
–
–
1.4
0.13
0.18
0.28
0.105
0.125
0.175
9.9
10.0
10.1
9.9
10.0
10.1
–
0.5
–
11.8
12.0
12.2
11.8
12.0
12.2
0.3
0.5
0.7
1.0
–
–
0.45
0.6
0.75
–
0.25
–
–
–
0.08
–
–
0.1
–
0°
10°
–
–
0.225
1.0
–
–
–
–
10.4
–
–
10.4
3803/3804 Group
64P4B
Plastic 64pin 750mil SDIP
JEDEC Code
–
Lead Material
Alloy 42
Weight(g)
7.9
33
1
32
E
64
e1
c
EIAJ Package Code
SDIP64-P-750-1.78
Symbol
A1
L
A
A2
D
e
SEATING PLANE
Rev.4.01
Nov 14, 2003
page 130 of 136
b1
b
b2
A
A1
A2
b
b1
b2
c
D
E
e
e1
L
Dimension in Millimeters
Max
Nom
Min
5.08
–
–
–
–
0.38
–
3.8
–
0.6
0.5
0.4
1.3
1.0
0.9
1.05
0.75
0.65
0.32
0.25
0.2
56.6
56.4
56.2
17.15
17.0
16.85
–
1.778
–
–
19.05
–
–
–
2.8
15°
–
0°
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
3803/3804 GROUP DATA SHEET
Date
Description
Summary
Page
0.1
03/15/99
First Edition; Only including overview
The issue including all information will be released in April.
1.0
05/25/99
Functional descriptions are added.
2.0
09/09/99
All pages
9
10
34
52
60
63
66
67
68
69
75
76
77
82
86
117
3.0
06/28/00
1
1
1
1
9
11-13
14
“PRELIMINARY Notice: This is...” eliminated.
Product names are added into Figure 8.
Product names are added into Table 3.
Explanation of “Timer divider” of “8-bit Timers” is revised.
Explanation of Note 7 is revised.
Explanation of Note 7 is revised.
Explanation of “A-D CONVERTER” is revised.
Explanations of Figure 56 are partly revised.
Explanations of “Watchdog Timer Initial Value” and “Watchdog Timer Operations”
are revised.
Explanations of Figure 60 are partly revised.
Explanation of “MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS INTERFACE” is revised.
Explanation of Note eliminated.
Explanations of Figure 62 are partly revised.
Explanations of “I2C Data Shift Register” and “I2C Address Registers 0 to 2” are
revised.
Explanation of Bit 5 of “I2C Clock Control Register” is revised.
Value of “Setup time” and “Hold time” into Table 13 are revised.
Explanation of Bit 5 of “I2C Special Mode Status Register” is added.
Note is added into Figure 73.
Explanation of Bit 1 of “I2C Special Mode Control Register” is added.
Explanation of Bit 6 of “I2C Special Mode Control Register” is revised.
Note is added into Figure 74.
Register Contents of (21) into Figure 78 is revised.
Explanations of Figure 82 are partly revised.
Note 2 into Figure 82 is revised.
Table 28 is revised for only flash memory version.
Table 29 is added.
“●Minimum instruction execution time” of “FEATURES” is revised.
“●Memory size” of “FEATURES” is revised.
“<Flash memory mode>” of “FEATURES” is revised.
“■Notes” of “FEATURES” is revised.
Figure 8 is partly revised.
Explanations of “CENTRAL PROCESSING UNIT (CPU)” are added.
Explanation of bit 3 of “CPU mode register” is revised.
(1/5)
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
3803/3804 GROUP DATA SHEET
Date
Description
Summary
Page
3.0
06/28/00
21
22
24
25
37
37
37
37
37
37
37
37
37
37
38
38
38
38
38
38
39
42
42
42
43
(7) into Figure 16 is partly revised.
(14) into Figure 17 is partly revised.
(7) into Figure 19 is partly revised.
(14) into Figure 20 is partly revised.
Explanations of “Timer divider” are partly eliminated.
“●Prescaler 12” is added.
Explanations of “Timer 1 and Timer 2” are partly eliminated.
“Prescaler X and prescaler Y” is added.
Explanations of “Timer X and Timer Y” are partly eliminated.
Explanations of “●Mode selection” and “●Explanation of operation” of “(1)
Timer mode” of “Timer X and Timer Y” are partly eliminated.
“●Count source selection” and “●Interrupt” of “(1) Timer mode” of “Timer X and
Timer Y” are eliminated.
“●Count source selection” and “●Interrupt” of “(2) Pulse output mode” of “Timer X
and Timer Y” are eliminated.
Explanations of “●Explanation of operation” of “(2) Pulse output mode” of “Timer
X and Timer Y” are partly added.
Explanations of “■Precautions” of “(2) Pulse output mode” of “Timer X and Timer
Y” are partly eliminated.
Explanations of “●Mode selection” and “●Explanation of operation” of “(3) Event
counter mode” of “Timer X and Timer Y” are revised.
“●Interrupt” of “(3) Event counter mode” of “Timer X and Timer Y” are eliminated.
“■Precautions” of “(3) Event counter mode” of “Timer X and Timer Y” are added.
“●Count source selection” of “(4) Pulse width measurement mode” of “Timer X
and Timer Y” are eliminated.
Explanations of “●Explanation of operation” of “(4) Pulse width measurement
mode” of “Timer X and Timer Y” are partly eliminated.
Explanations of “■Precautions” of “(4) Pulse width measurement mode” of “Timer
X and Timer Y” are revised.
Bit name into Figure 29 is partly added.
Explanations of “●Mode selection” of “(1) Timer mode” of “●16-bit Timers” are
partly added.
Explanations of “●Explanation of operation” of “(1) Timer mode” of “●16-bit Timers” are partly eliminated.
Explanations of “●Mode selection” of “(3) Pulse output mode” of “●16-bit Timers”
are partly added.
Explanations of “●Mode selection” of “(4) Pulse period measurement mode” of
“●16-bit Timers” are partly added.
(2/5)
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
3803/3804 GROUP DATA SHEET
Date
Description
Summary
Page
3.0
06/28/00
43
44
44
45
46
55
63
68
70
71
74
75
78
78
79
79
80
80
80
80
84
110
111
114
121
122
123
123
Explanations of “●Mode selection” of “(5) Pulse width measurement mode” of
“●16-bit Timers” are partly added.
Explanations of “●Mode selection” of “(6) Programmable waveform generating
mode” of “●16-bit Timers” are partly added.
Explanations of “●Mode selection” of “(7) Programmable one-shot generating
mode” of “●16-bit Timers” are partly added.
Figure 32 is partly revised.
Note into Figure 33 is added.
Explanations of “7. Transmit interrupt request when transmit enable bit is set” are
revised.
Explanations of “7. Transmit interrupt request when transmit enable bit is set” are
revised.
Explanations of “D-A CONVERTER” are partly eliminated.
Figure 64 is partly revised.
Explanations of “[I2C Slave Address Registers 0 to 2 (S0D0 to S0D2)]” are partly
added.
Explanations of “•Bit 3: Arbitration lost detecting flag (AL)” of “[I2C Status Register
(S1)]” are partly added.
Explanations of “•Bit 7: Communication mode specification bit (master/slave
specification bit: MST)” of “[I2C Status Register (S1)]” are partly revised.
“•Bit 7: Data receive mode at Stop/Low-speed mode bit (STR)” of “[I2C
START/STOP Condition Control Register (S2D)]” is eliminated.
Explanations of b7 into Figure 74 are revised.
“•Bit 4: Time out flag (TIOUT)” of “[I2C Special Mode Status Register (S3)]” is
eliminated.
Figure 75 is partly revised.
“•Bit 0: I2C time out control bit (TOEN)” is eliminated.
“•Bit 4: Time out flag clear bit (TOFCL)” is eliminated.
Figure 76 is partly revised.
Note into Figure 76 is added.
Explanations of “RESET CIRCUIT” are partly revised.
Explanations of “Functional Outline (CPU reprogramming mode)” of “(3) Flash
memory mode 3 (CPU reprogramming mode)” are partly eliminated.
Explanations of b3, b1, b0 into Figure 103 are partly revised.
Explanations of “Instruction Execution Time” are partly reviesd.
Table 31 is partly eliminated.
Limits of RO into Table 34 are revised.
Limits and unit of tw(RESET) into Table 35 are revised.
Symbol of th(SCLK3–RxD3) into Table 35 is revised.
(3/5)
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
3803/3804 GROUP DATA SHEET
Date
Description
Summary
Page
3.0
06/28/00
124
125
4.0
05/15/02
9
15
21
22
23
24
25
26
31
42
43
43
44
54
54
55
56
62
62
63
70
71
76
77
78
83
87
87
89
91
91
93
94
95
95
96
97
97
98
Limits and unit of tw(RESET) into Table 36 are revised.
Limits of tWH(SCLK1), tWH(SCLK3) into Tables 37 and 38 are partly added.
Figure 8 is partly revised.
Sub-sub clause name of “●Middle-speed mode automatic switch by program” is
partly eliminated.
Figure 16 is partly revised.
Figure 17 is partly revised.
Figure 18 is partly revised.
Figure 19 is partly revised.
Figure 20 is partly revised.
Figure 21 is partly revised.
Explanations of “■Notes” are revised.
Explanations of “●16-bit Timers” are partly revised.
Explanations of “●Explanation of operation” of “(4) Pulse period measurement
mode” are revised.
Explanations of “●Explanation of operation” of “(5) Pulse width measurement mode”
are revised.
Explanations of “●Explanation of operation” of “(7) Programmable one-shot generating mode” are partly revised.
Explanations of “●Note” of “2.1 Stop of transmission operation” are partly added.
Explanations of “●Note 1 (only transmission operation is stopped)” of “2.3 Stop of
transmit/receive operation” are partly added.
Explanations of “5. Data transmission control with referring to transmit shift register completion flag” are partly added.
Figure 46 is partly revised.
Explanations of “●Note” of “2.1 Stop of transmission operation” are partly added.
Explanations of “●Note 1 (only transmission operation is stopped)” of “2.2 Stop of
transmit/receive operation” are partly added.
Explanations of “5. Data transmission control with referring to transmit shift register completion flag” are partly added.
Explanations of “MULTI-MASTER I2C-BUS INTERFACE” are partly revised.
Explanations of “[I2C Data Shift Register (S0)]” are partly revised.
Explanations of “START Condition Generating Method” are partly revised.
Table 14 is partly revised.
Table 15 is partly revised.
Explanations of “2” of “(2) Start condition generating procedure using multi-master” are partly revised.
Explanations of “CLOCK GENERATING CIRCUIT” are partly revised.
Explanations of “■Note” of “(2) Wait mode” are partly added.
Figure 84 is partly revised.
Explanations of “(1) Flash memory mode 1 (parallel I/O mode)” are partly revised.
Table 16 is partly revised.
Figure 86 is partly revised.
Figure 87 is partly revised.
Explanations of “Read-only Mode” are partly revised.
Explanations of “Read/Write Mode” are partly revised.
Explanations of “●Read command” are partly revised.
Explanations of “●Program command” are partly revised.
Explanations of “●Program verify command” are partly revised.
Explanations of “●Erase verify command” are partly revised.
(4/5)
REVISION HISTORY
Rev.
4.0
Date
05/15/02
4.01 Nov. 14, 2003
3803/3804 GROUP DATA SHEET
115
116
117
117
129
Description
Summary
Limits of tRC into Table 21 are revised.
Limits of ta(AD) into Table 21 are revised.
Limits of ta(CE) into Table 21 are revised.
Limits of ta(OE) into Table 21 are revised.
Figure 93 is partly revised.
Figure 94 is partly revised.
“Electric Characteristic Differences Between Mask ROM and Flash Memory Version MCUs” is added.
Explanations of “DATA REQUIRED FOR MASK ORDERS” are partly added.
Explanations of “Note” into Table 27 are partly revised.
VCC into Table 28 are partly added.
Parameter of VIH into Table 28 is partly revised.
64P6Q-A package outline is partly revised.
6
7
13
19
20
31
73
87
89
93
94
102
103
122
Table 1 is partly revised.
Table 2 is partly revised.
Explanations of “[Processor status register (PS)]” are partly revised.
Table 6 is partly revised.
Table 7 is partly revised.
Explanations of “■Notes” are partly revised.
Figure 67 is partly revised.
Explanations of “(2) Wait mode” is partly revised.
Figure 84 is partly revised.
Figure 86 is partly revised.
Figure 87 is partly revised.
Figure 93 is partly revised.
Figure 94 is partly revised.
Table 35 is partly revised.
Page
101
101
101
101
102
103
115
(5/5)
Sales Strategic Planning Div.
Nippon Bldg., 2-6-2, Ohte-machi, Chiyoda-ku, Tokyo 100-0004, Japan
Keep safety first in your circuit designs!
1. Renesas Technology Corporation puts the maximum effort into making semiconductor products better and more reliable, but there is always the possibility that trouble may occur with
them. Trouble with semiconductors may lead to personal injury, fire or property damage.
Remember to give due consideration to safety when making your circuit designs, with appropriate measures such as (i) placement of substitutive, auxiliary circuits, (ii) use of
nonflammable material or (iii) prevention against any malfunction or mishap.
Notes regarding these materials
1. These materials are intended as a reference to assist our customers in the selection of the Renesas Technology Corporation product best suited to the customer’s application; they
do not convey any license under any intellectual property rights, or any other rights, belonging to Renesas Technology Corporation or a third party.
2. Renesas Technology Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage, or infringement of any third-party’s rights, originating in the use of any product data, diagrams, charts,
programs, algorithms, or circuit application examples contained in these materials.
3. All information contained in these materials, including product data, diagrams, charts, programs and algorithms represents information on products at the time of publication of these
materials, and are subject to change by Renesas Technology Corporation without notice due to product improvements or other reasons. It is therefore recommended that customers
contact Renesas Technology Corporation or an authorized Renesas Technology Corporation product distributor for the latest product information before purchasing a product listed
herein.
The information described here may contain technical inaccuracies or typographical errors.
Renesas Technology Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage, liability, or other loss rising from these inaccuracies or errors.
Please also pay attention to information published by Renesas Technology Corporation by various means, including the Renesas Technology Corporation Semiconductor home page
(http://www.renesas.com).
4. When using any or all of the information contained in these materials, including product data, diagrams, charts, programs, and algorithms, please be sure to evaluate all information
as a total system before making a final decision on the applicability of the information and products. Renesas Technology Corporation assumes no responsibility for any damage,
liability or other loss resulting from the information contained herein.
5. Renesas Technology Corporation semiconductors are not designed or manufactured for use in a device or system that is used under circumstances in which human life is potentially
at stake. Please contact Renesas Technology Corporation or an authorized Renesas Technology Corporation product distributor when considering the use of a product contained
herein for any specific purposes, such as apparatus or systems for transportation, vehicular, medical, aerospace, nuclear, or undersea repeater use.
6. The prior written approval of Renesas Technology Corporation is necessary to reprint or reproduce in whole or in part these materials.
7. If these products or technologies are subject to the Japanese export control restrictions, they must be exported under a license from the Japanese government and cannot be
imported into a country other than the approved destination.
Any diversion or reexport contrary to the export control laws and regulations of Japan and/or the country of destination is prohibited.
8. Please contact Renesas Technology Corporation for further details on these materials or the products contained therein.
http://www.renesas.com
© 2003. Renesas Technology Corp., All rights reserved. Printed in Japan.